AVR-2808
Transcription
AVR-2808
AV SURROUND RECEIVER AVR-2808 Owner’s Manual Bedienungsanleitung Manuel de l’Utilisateur 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 1 v Book 1 English Deutsch Français PRESET CODE Book 2 Italiano Español Nederlands Svenska 2007/09/28 11:40:06 ENGLISH DEUTSCH FRANCAIS ITALIANO ESPAÑOL NEDERLANDS SVENSKA nSAFETY PRECAUTIONS CAUTION RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN CAUTION: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER-SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER SERVICING TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. WARNING: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE OR ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS APPLIANCE TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. • DECLARATION OF CONFORMITY We declare under our sole responsibility that this product, to which this declaration relates, is in conformity with the following standards: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 and EN61000-3-3. Following the provisions of 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC and 93/68/EEC Directive. • ÜBEREINSTIMMUNGSERKLÄRUNG CAUTION: To completely disconnect this product from the mains, disconnect the plug from the wall socket outlet. The mains plug is used to completely interrupt the power supply to the unit and must be within easy access by the user. VORSICHT: Wir erklären unter unserer Verantwortung, daß dieses Produkt, auf das sich diese Erklärung bezieht, den folgenden Standards entspricht: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 und EN61000-3-3. Entspricht den Verordnungen der Direktive 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC und 93/68/EEC. Um dieses Gerät vollständig von der Stromversorgung abzutrennen, ziehen Sie bitte den Stecker aus der Wandsteckdose. Der Netzstecker wird verwendet, um die Stromversorgung zum Gerät völlig zu unterbrechen; er muss für den Benutzer gut und einfach zu erreichen sein. • DECLARATION DE CONFORMITE PRECAUTION: Nous déclarons sous notre seule responsabilité que l’appareil, auquel se réfère cette déclaration, est conforme aux standards suivants: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 et EN61000-3-3. D’après les dispositions de la Directive 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC et 93/68/ EEC. • DICHIARAZIONE DI CONFORMITÀ Pour déconnecter complètement ce produit du courant secteur, débranchez la prise de la prise murale. La prise secteur est utilisée pour couper complètement l’alimentation de l’appareil et l’utilisateur doit pouvoir y accéder facilement. Dichiariamo con piena responsabilità che questo prodotto, al quale la nostra dichiarazione si riferisce, è conforme alle seguenti normative: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 e EN61000-3-3. In conformità con le condizioni delle direttive 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC e 93/68/EEC. QUESTO PRODOTTO E’ CONFORME AL D.M. 28/08/95 N. 548 ATTENZIONE: Per scollegare completamente questo prodotto dalla rete di alimentazione elettrica, scollegare la spina dalla relativa presa a muro. La spina di rete viene utilizzata per interrompere completamente l’alimentazione all’unità e deve essere facilmente accessibile all’utente. • DECLARACIÓN DE CONFORMIDAD PRECAUCIÓN: Declaramos bajo nuestra exclusiva responsabilidad que este producto al que hace referencia esta declaración, está conforme con los siguientes estándares: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 y EN61000-3-3. Siguiendo las provisiones de las Directivas 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC y 93/68/EEC. • EENVORMIGHEIDSVERKLARING Wij verklaren uitsluitend op onze verantwoordelijkheid dat dit produkt, waarop deze verklaring betrekking heeft, in overeenstemming is met de volgende normen: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 en EN61000-3-3. Volgens de bepalingen van de Richtlijnen 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC en 93/68/EEC. • ÖVERENSSTÄMMELSESINTYG Härmed intygas helt på eget ansvar att denna produkt, vilken detta intyg avser, uppfyller följande standarder: EN60065, EN55013, EN55020, EN61000-3-2 och EN61000-3-3. Enligt stadgarna i direktiv 2006/95/EC, 89/336/EEC och 93/68/EEC. Para desconectar completamente este producto de la alimentación eléctrica, desconecte el enchufe del enchufe de la pared. El enchufe de la alimentación eléctrica se utiliza para interrumpir por completo el suministro de alimentación eléctrica a la unidad y debe de encontrarse en un lugar al que el usuario tenga fácil acceso. WAARSCHUWING: Om de voeding van dit product volledig te onderbreken moet de stekker uit het stopcontact worden getrokken. De netstekker wordt gebruikt om de stroomtoevoer naar het toestel volledig te onderbreken en moet voor de gebruiker gemakkelijk bereikbaar zijn. FÖRSIKTIHETSMÅTT: Koppla loss stickproppen från eluttaget för att helt skilja produkten från nätet. Stickproppen används för att helt bryta strömförsörjningen till apparaten, och den måste vara lättillgänglig för användaren. I 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 2 2007/09/28 11:40:07 SVENSKA NEDERLANDS ESPAÑOL ITALIANO FRANCAIS DEUTSCH ENGLISH nNOTE ON USE / HINWEISE ZUM GEBRAUCH / OBSERVATIONS RELATIVES A L’UTILISATION / NOTE SULL’USO / NOTAS SOBRE EL USO / ALVORENS TE GEBRUIKEN / OBSERVERA ANGÅENDE ANVÄNDNINGEN CAUTION: •The ventilation should not be impeded by covering the ventilation openings with items, such as newspapers, tablecloths, curtains, etc. • No naked flame sources, such as lighted candles, should be placed on the unit. • Observe and follow local regulations regarding battery disposal. • Do not expose the unit to dripping or splashing fluids. • Do not place objects filled with liquids, such as vases, on the unit. ACHTUNG: • Do not let foreign objects into the unit. • Keep the unit free from moisture, water, and dust. • Lassen Sie keine fremden Gegenstände in das Gerät kommen. • Halten Sie das Gerät von Feuchtigkeit, Wasser und Staub • Ne pas laisser des objets étrangers dans l’appareil. • Avoid high temperatures. fern. • Non inserite corpi estranei all’interno dell’unità. Allow for sufficient heat dispersion when installed in a rack. • Protéger l’appareil contre l’humidité, l’eau et la poussière. • No deje objetos extraños dentro del equipo. • Vermeiden Sie hohe Temperaturen. Beachten Sie, dass eine ausreichende Belüftung gewährleistet • Tenete l’unità lontana dall’umidità, dall’acqua e dalla • Laat geen vreemde voorwerpen in dit apparaat vallen. polvere. • Se till att främmande föremål inte tränger in i apparaten. wird, wenn das Gerät auf ein Regal gestellt wird. • Mantenga el equipo libre de humedad, agua y polvo. • Eviter des températures élevées. • Laat geen vochtigheid, water of stof in het apparaat Tenir compte d’une dispersion de chaleur suffisante lors de binnendringen. l’installation sur une étagère. • Utsätt inte apparaten för fukt, vatten och damm. • Evitate di esporre l’unità a temperature elevate. Assicuratevi che vi sia un’adeguata dispersione del calore quando installate l’unità in un mobile per componenti audio. • Evite altas temperaturas. Permite la suficiente dispersión del calor cuando está instalado en la consola. • Vermijd hoge temperaturen. Zorg er bij installatie in een audiorack voor, dat de door • Do not let insecticides, benzene, and thinner come in het toestel geproduceerde warmte goed kan worden contact with the unit. afgevoerd. • Lassen Sie das Gerät nicht mit Insektiziden, Benzin oder • Unplug the power cord when not using the unit for long • Undvik höga temperaturer. Verdünnungsmitteln in Berührung kommen. periods of time. Se till att det finns möjlighet till god värmeavledning vid • Ne pas mettre en contact des insecticides, du benzène et • Wenn das Gerät längere Zeit nicht verwendet werden soll, montering i ett rack. un diluant avec l’appareil. trennen Sie das Netzkabel vom Netzstecker. • Assicuratevi che l’unità non entri in contatto con insetticidi, • Débrancher le cordon d’alimentation lorsque l’appareil n’est benzolo o solventi. pas utilisé pendant de longues périodes. • No permita el contacto de insecticidas, gasolina y diluyentes • Scollegate il cavo di alimentazione quando prevedete di non con el equipo. utilizzare l’unità per un lungo periodo di tempo. • Voorkom dat insecticiden, benzeen of verfverdunner met dit • Desconecte el cordón de energía cuando no utilice el equipo toestel in contact komen. por mucho tiempo. • Se till att inte insektsmedel på spraybruk, bensen och • Neem altijd het netsnoer uit het stopkontakt wanneer het thinner kommer i kontakt med apparatens hölje. apparaat gedurende een lange periode niet wordt gebruikt. • Koppla loss nätkabeln om apparaten inte kommer att användas i lång tid. • Handle the power cord carefully. Hold the plug when unplugging the cord. • Gehen Sie vorsichtig mit dem Netzkabel um. Halten Sie das Kabel am Stecker, wenn Sie den Stecker herausziehen. • Manipuler le cordon d’alimentation avec précaution. Tenir la prise lors du débranchement du cordon. • Manneggiate il cavo di alimentazione con attenzione. Tenete ferma la spina quando scollegate il cavo dalla presa. • Never disassemble or modify the unit in any way. * (For apparatuses with ventilation holes) • Maneje el cordón de energía con cuidado. • Versuchen Sie niemals das Gerät auseinander zu nehmen Sostenga el enchufe cuando desconecte el cordón de • Do not obstruct the ventilation holes. oder zu verändern. energía. • Ne jamais démonter ou modifier l’appareil d’une manière ou • Decken Sie den Lüftungsbereich nicht ab. • Hanteer het netsnoer voorzichtig. d’une autre. • Ne pas obstruer les trous d’aération. Houd het snoer bij de stekker vast wanneer deze moet • Non coprite i fori di ventilazione. • Non smontate né modificate l’unità in alcun modo. worden aan- of losgekoppeld. • Nunca desarme o modifique el equipo de ninguna manera. • No obstruya los orificios de ventilación. • Hantera nätkabeln varsamt. • Dit toestel mag niet gedemonteerd of aangepast worden. • De ventilatieopeningen mogen niet worden beblokkeerd. Håll i kabeln när den kopplas från el-uttaget. • Ta inte isär apparaten och försök inte bygga om den. • Täpp inte till ventilationsöppningarna. •Die Belüftung sollte auf keinen Fall durch das Abdecken der Belüftungsöffnungen durch Gegenstände wie beispielsweise Zeitungen, Tischtücher, Vorhänge o. Ä. behindert werden. •Auf dem Gerät sollten keinerlei direkte Feuerquellen wie beispielsweise angezündete Kerzen aufgestellt werden. •Bitte beachten Sie bei der Entsorgung der Batterien die örtlich geltenden Umweltbestimmungen. •Das Gerät sollte keiner tropfenden oder spritzenden Flüssigkeit ausgesetzt werden. •Auf dem Gerät sollten keine mit Flüssigkeit gefüllten Behälter wie beispielsweise Vasen aufgestellt werden. ATTENTION: •La ventilation ne doit pas être gênée en recouvrant les ouvertures de la ventilation avec des objets tels que journaux, rideaux, tissus, etc. • Aucune flamme nue, par exemple une bougie, ne doit être placée sur l’appareil. • Veillez à respecter les lois en vigueur lorsque vous jetez les piles usagées. • L’appareil ne doit pas être exposé à l’eau ou à l’humidité. • Ne pas poser d’objet contenant du liquide, par exemple un vase, sur l’appareil. ATTENZIONE: •Le aperture di ventilazione non devono essere ostruite coprendole con oggetti, quali giornali, tovaglie, tende e così via. • Non posizionate sull’unità fiamme libere, come ad esempio candele accese. •Prestate attenzione agli aspetti legati alla tutela dell’ambiente nello smaltimento delle batterie. • L’apparecchiatura non deve essere esposta a gocciolii o spruzzi. •Non posizionate sull’unità alcun oggetto contenente liquidi, come ad esempio i vasi. PRECAUCIÓN: •La ventilación no debe quedar obstruida por haberse cubierto las aperturas con objetos como periódicos, manteles, cortinas, etc. •No debe colocarse sobre el aparato ninguna fuente inflamable sin protección, como velas encendidas. •A la hora de deshacerse de las pilas, respete la normativa para el cuidado del medio ambiente. • No exponer el aparato al goteo o salpicaduras cuando se utilice. • No colocar sobre el aparato objetos llenos de líquido, como jarros. WAARSCHUWING: •De ventilatie mag niet worden belemmerd door de ventilatieopeningen af te dekken met bijvoorbeeld kranten, een tafelkleed, gordijnen, enz. • Plaats geen open vlammen, bijvoorbeeld een brandende kaars, op het apparaat. • Houd u steeds aan de milieuvoorschriften wanneer u gebruikte batterijen wegdoet. • Stel het apparaat niet bloot aan druppels of spatten. • Plaats geen voorwerpen gevuld met water, bijvoorbeeld een vaas, op het apparaat. OBSERVERA: •Ventilationen bör inte förhindras genom att täcka för ventilationsöppningarna med föremål såsom tidningar, bordsdukar, gardiner osv. • Inga blottade brandkällor, såsom tända ljus, får placeras på apparaten. • Tänk på miljöaspekterna när du bortskaffar batterier. • Apparaten får inte utsättas för vätska. • Placera inte föremål fyllda med vätska, t.ex. vaser, på apparaten. II 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 3 2007/09/28 11:40:08 ENGLISH DEUTSCH FRANCAIS ITALIANO ESPAÑOL NEDERLANDS SVENSKA A NOTE ABOUT RECYCLING: This product’s packaging materials are recyclable and can be reused. Please dispose of any materials in accordance with the local recycling regulations. When discarding the unit, comply with local rules or regulations. Batteries should never be thrown away or incinerated but disposed of in accordance with the local regulations concerning battery disposal. This product and the supplied accessories, excluding the batteries, constitute the applicable product according to the WEEE directive. HINWEIS ZUM RECYCLING: Das Verpackungsmaterial dieses Produktes ist zum Recyceln geeignet und kann wieder verwendet werden. Bitte entsorgen Sie alle Materialien entsprechend der örtlichen Recycling-Vorschriften. Beachten Sie bei der Entsorgung des Gerätes die örtlichen Vorschriften und Bestimmungen. Die Batterien dürfen nicht in den Hausmüll geworfen oder verbrannt werden; bitte entsorgen Sie die Batterien gemäß der örtlichen Vorschriften. Dieses Produkt und das im Lieferumfang enthaltene Zubehör (mit Ausnahme der Batterien!) entsprechen der WEEEDirektive. UNE REMARQUE CONCERNANT LE RECYCLAGE: Les matériaux d’emballage de ce produit sont recyclables et peuvent être réutilisés. Veuillez disposer des matériaux conformément aux lois sur le recyclage en vigueur. Lorsque vous mettez cet appareil au rebut, respectez les lois ou réglementations en vigueur. Les piles ne doivent jamais être jetées ou incinérées, mais mises au rebut conformément aux lois en vigueur sur la mise au rebut des piles. Ce produit et les accessoires inclus, à l’exception des piles, sont des produits conformes à la directive DEEE. NOTA RELATIVA AL RICICLAGGIO: I materiali di imballaggio di questo prodotto sono riutilizzabili e riciclabili. Smaltire i materiali conformemente alle normative locali sul riciclaggio. Per lo smaltimento dell’unità, osservare le normative o le leggi locali in vigore. Non gettare le batterie, né incenerirle, ma smaltirle conformemente alla normativa locale sui rifiuti chimici. Questo prodotto e gli accessori inclusi nell’imballaggio sono applicabili alla direttiva RAEE, ad eccezione delle batterie. ACERCA DEL RECICLAJE: Los materiales de embalaje de este producto son reciclables y se pueden volver a utilizar. Disponga de estos materiales siguiendo los reglamentos de reciclaje de su localidad. Cuando se deshaga de la unidad, cumpla con las reglas o reglamentos locales. Las pilas nunca deberán tirarse ni incinerarse. Deberá disponer de ellas siguiendo los reglamentos de su localidad relacionados con los desperdicios químicos. Este producto junto con los accesorios empaquetados es el producto aplicable a la directiva RAEE excepto pilas. EEN AANTEKENING MET BETREKKING TOT DE RECYCLING: Het inpakmateriaal van dit product is recycleerbaar en kan opnieuw gebruikt worden. Er wordt verzocht om zich van elk afvalmateriaal te ontdoen volgens de plaatselijke voorschriften. Volg voor het wegdoen van de speler de voorschriften voor de verwijdering van wit- en bruingoed op. Batterijen mogen nooit worden weggegooid of verbrand, maar moeten volgens de plaatselijke voorschriften betreffende chemisch afval worden verwijderd. Op dit product en de meegeleverde accessoires, m.u.v. de batterijen is de richtlijn voor afgedankte elektrische en elektronische apparaten (WEEE) van toepassing. OBSERVERA ANGÅENDE ÅTERVINNING: Produktens emballage är återvinningsbart och kan återanvändas. Kassera det enligt lokala återvinningsbestämmelser. När du kasserar enheten ska du göra det i överensstämmelse med lokala regler och bestämmelser. Batterier får absolut inte kastas i soporna eller brännas. Kassera dem enligt lokala bestämmelser för kemiskt avfall. Denna apparat och de tillbehör som levereras med den uppfyller gällande WEEE-direktiv, med undantag av batterierna. III 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 4 2007/09/28 11:40:09 ENGLISH Contents Getting Started Accessories·······················································································2 Cautions on Handling······································································3 Cautions on Installation··································································3 About the Remote Control Unit·····················································3 Inserting the Batteries·····································································3 Operating Range of the Remote Control Unit·································3 Part Names and Functions······························································4 Front Panel······················································································4 Display····························································································4 Rear Panel·······················································································5 Remote Control Unit·······································································6 Connections Preparations·····················································································7 Cables Used for Connections·························································7 Video Conversion Function······························································8 On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and HDMI Output··················································································8 Speaker Connections······································································9 Speaker Installation·········································································9 Speaker Connections································································ 9, 10 Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors·························· 11 Connecting the Monitor································································ 12 Connecting the Playback Components······································· 12 DVD Player···················································································· 12 Record Player················································································ 13 CD Player······················································································ 13 iPod®····························································································· 14 TV/CABLE Tuner············································································ 14 Satellite Receiver·········································································· 15 Connecting the Recording Components····································· 15 Digital Video Recorder··································································· 15 Video Cassette Recorder······························································ 16 CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck······································ 16 Connections to Other Devices······················································ 17 Video Camera / Game Console····················································· 17 Component with Multi-channel Output connectors······················ 17 External Power Amplifier······························································· 17 Antenna terminals · ······································································ 18 Multi-zone····················································································· 19 External Controller········································································ 19 Connecting the Power Cord·························································20 Once Connections are Completed···············································20 Menu Operations Operations······················································································20 Example of Display of Default Values··········································21 Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display·····················21 Menu Map······················································································22 Auto Setup Preparations···················································································23 Auto Setup·····················································································24 a Start Menu···············································································24 Error Messages········································································25 s Option······················································································25 d Parameter Check······································································25 Manual Setup Speaker Setup···············································································26 a Speaker Configuration······························································26 s Subwoofer Setup·····································································26 d Distance·············································································26, 27 f Channel Level··········································································27 g Crossover Frequency·······························································27 HDMI Setup····················································································27 a HDMI Audio Setup···································································27 s HDMI Video Setup···································································28 Audio Setup···················································································28 a EXT. IN Subwoofer Level··························································28 s 2ch Direct/Stereo·······························································28, 29 d Dolby Digital Setup··································································29 f Auto Surround Mode·······························································29 g Manual EQ···············································································29 Zone Setup·····················································································30 a ZONE2 Setup···········································································30 s ZONE3 Setup···········································································30 Option Setup··················································································31 a Amp Assign··············································································31 s Volume Control········································································31 d Source Delete··········································································31 f On-Screen Display·····························································31, 32 g Quick Select Name··································································32 h Trigger Out···············································································32 j Remote ID Setup·····································································32 k 2Way Remote··········································································32 l Display·····················································································32 A0 Setup Lock···············································································33 Input Setup Settings Related to Playing Input Sources··································34 Auto Preset···················································································34 Preset Skip····················································································34 Preset Name·················································································34 Input Mode···················································································34 Rename·························································································34 Assign···························································································35 iPod·························································································35, 36 Other·····························································································36 Surround Modes Standard Playback·········································································36 Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources······································36 Playing Multi-channel Sources (Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.)··············37 DSP Simulation Playback·····························································37 Stereo Playback·············································································37 Direct Playback··············································································37 Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode············································38 Parameter a Surround Parameter···························································38 ~ 40 s Tone Control···············································································40 d Room EQ····················································································40 f RESTORER·················································································41 g Night Mode················································································41 h Audio Delay················································································41 Information Status·····························································································41 a Main Zone················································································41 s ZONE2 / ZONE3·······································································41 Audio Input Signal·········································································42 HDMI Information··········································································42 a HDMI Signal Information·························································42 s HDMI Monitor Information······················································42 Auto Surround Mode·····································································42 Quick Select···················································································42 Preset Station················································································42 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 5 2007/09/28 11:40:09 ENGLISH Getting Started Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Playback Preparations···················································································43 Turning the Power On···································································43 Selecting the Input Source····························································43 Operations During Playback··························································43 Playing Video and Audio Equipment············································44 Basic Operation·············································································44 Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts··················································44 Basic Operation·············································································44 Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory)··································44 Listening to Preset Stations··························································45 RDS (Radio Data System)·····························································45 RDS Search···················································································45 PTY Search····················································································46 TP Search······················································································46 RT (Radio Text)···············································································47 iPod® Playback··············································································47 Basic Operation·············································································47 Listening to Music···································································47, 48 Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the iPod··································48 Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting Other Operations and Functions Other Operations···········································································48 Playing Super Audio CD································································48 Recording on an External Device (REC OUT mode)······················49 Convenient Functions···································································49 Channel Level················································································49 Fader Function··············································································49 Quick Select Function···································································50 Personal Memory Plus Function···················································50 Last Function Memory··································································50 Backup Memory············································································50 Resetting the Microprocessor·······················································50 Remote Control Unit Operations Main Remote Control Unit···························································51 Operating DENON Audio Components·········································51 Presetting······················································································51 Operating Preset Components·············································51 ~ 53 Setting the Remote ID··································································54 Learning Function··········································································54 System Call Function·····································································55 Punch Through Function································································55 Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit········································55 Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness·············································55 Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit······································56 Sub Remote Control Unit·····························································57 Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function··········57 ~ 59 Multi-zone Settings and Operations with Zone Pre-out Output·····59 Multi-zone Operations··································································60 Turning the Power On and Off······················································60 Selecting the Input Source····························································60 Adjusting the Volume····································································60 Turning off the Sound Temporarily·················································60 Other Information·································································61 ~ 69 Troubleshooting······································································ 70, 71 Getting Started Thank you for purchasing this DENON product. To ensure proper operation, please read this owner’s manual carefully before using the product. After reading them, be sure to keep them for future reference. Accessories Check that the following parts are supplied with the product. qOwner’s manual....................................................................... 1 wService station list.................................................................... 1 ePower cord (Cord length: Approx. 1.5 m).................................. 1 rMain remote control (RC-1068)................................................ 1 tLR6/AA batteries (for RC-1068)................................................. 2 ySub remote control (RC-1071).................................................. 1 uR03/AAA batteries (for RC-1071).............................................. 2 iFM indoor antenna................................................................... 1 oAM loop antenna...................................................................... 1 Q0Setup microphone (Cord length: Approx. 7.6 m)....................... 1 e r y i o Q0 Specifications················································································ 72 List of preset codes············································ End of this manual 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 6 2007/09/28 11:40:10 ENGLISH About the Remote Control Unit •Before turning the power switch on Check once again that all connections are correct and that there are no problems with the connection cables. Inserting the Batteries q Lift the clasp and remove the rear lid. (RC-1068) (RC-1071) (RC-1068) Point the remote control unit at the remote sensor when operating it. (RC-1071) R03/AAA LR6/AA (RC-1071) 30° e Put the rear cover back on. Troubleshooting Note: For proper heat dispersal, do not install this unit in a confined space, such as a bookcase or similar enclosure. 30° or Approx. 7 m bNote b (RC-1068) b Information Cautions on Installation Multi-Zone •Note that the illustrations in these instructions may differ from the actual unit for explanation purposes. w Load the two batteries properly as indicated by the marks in the battery compartment. Operating Range of the Remote Control Unit Remote Control •Moving the unit Turn off the power and unplug the power cord from the power outlet. Next, disconnect the connection cables to other system units before moving the unit. Playback •Cautions on using mobile phones Using a mobile phone near this unit may result in noise. If so, move the mobile phone away from this unit when it is in use. Setup •About condensation If there is a major difference in temperature between the inside of the unit and the surroundings, condensation (dew) may form on the operating parts inside the unit, causing the unit not to operate properly. If this happens, let the unit sit for an hour or two with the power turned off and wait until there is little difference in temperature before using the unit. Connections •Power is supplied to some of the circuitry even when the unit is set to the standby mode. When traveling or leaving home for long periods of time, be sure to unplug the power cord from the power outlet. In addition to the AVR-2808, the included main remote control unit (RC-1068) can also be used to operate the equipment listed below. qDENON system components wNon-DENON system components •By setting the preset memory (vpage 51 ~ 53) •By using the learn function (vpage 54) NOTE •Replace the batteries with new ones if the set does not operate even when the remote control unit is operated close to the unit. •The supplied batteries are only for verifying operation. •When inserting the batteries, be sure to do so in the proper direction, following the “q” and “w” marks in the battery compartment. •To prevent damage or leakage of battery fluid: •Do not use a new battery together with an old one. •Do not use two different types of batteries. •Do not attempt to charge dry batteries. •Do not short-circuit, disassemble, heat or dispose of batteries in flames. •If the battery fluid should leak, carefully wipe the fluid off the inside of the battery compartment and insert new batteries. •Remove the batteries from the remote control unit if it will not be in use for long periods. •When replacing the batteries, have the new batteries ready and insert them as quickly as possible. Getting Started Cautions on Handling NOTE The set may function improperly or the remote control unit may not operate if the remote control sensor is exposed to direct sunlight, strong artificial light from an inverter type fluorescent lamp or infrared light. b Wall 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 7 2007/09/28 11:40:11 ENGLISH Getting Started Part Names and Functions Display For buttons not explained here, see the page indicated in parentheses ( ). Q7 Front Panel Connections o i u y Q6 Q5 Q4 Q3 Q2 Q1 o Q0 i u y t Setup Playback q Q0 Q1 Q2 w qInput signal indicators wInput signal channel indicators Q3 Remote Control Multi-Zone q w e r GWith the door openH E4 E3 E2 E1 E0 W9 W8 W7 W6 W5 W4 W3 Information Troubleshooting Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 Q8 Q9 W0 W1 W2 qPower operation button (ON/STANDBY)············································ (43) wPower indicator············································ (43) ePower switch (hON jOFF)······················ (43) rQUICK SELECT buttons / indicators·········· (50) tMASTER VOLUME control knob················· (43) yMaster volume indicator uDisplay iRemote control sensor·································· (3) oSOURCE SELECT knob······························· (43) Q0SOURCE button··········································· (43) Q1TUNING PRESET button····························· (45) Q2ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT button··········· (49, 60) Q3VIDEO SELECT button································ (36) Q4Headphones jack (PHONES)······················· (43) Q5ZONE2 ON/OFF button······························· (60) Q6ZONE3 ON/OFF button······························· (60) Q7INPUT MODE button··································· (34) Q8MENU button··············································· (20) Q9Cursor buttons (uio p)··························· (20) W0CH SEL / ENTER button························ (20, 49) W1RETURN button··········································· (20) W2V.AUX INPUT connectors···························· (17) W3SETUP MIC jack··········································· (23) W4ROOM EQ button········································· (40) W5DIMMER button··········································· (32) W6SPEAKER button·········································· (43) W7SURROUND BACK button·························· (40) W8STATUS button············································ (42) W9AUDIO DELAY button·································· (41) E0RESTORER button······································· (41) E1DIRECT/STEREO button····························· (37) E2PURE DIRECT button··································· (38) E3DSP SIMULATION button··························· (37) E4STANDARD button······································ (36) The input source name, surround mode, setting values and other information are displayed here. rOutput signal channel indicators tFront speaker indicator These light according to the settings of the front A and B speakers. yHDMI monitor indicator This lights when an HDMI monitor is detected. This lights when the REC OUT mode is selected. Q0NIGHT indicator This lights when the night mode is selected. Q1Multi-zone indicators These light when the power for the respective zone is turned on. when playing using HDMI These light when the respective decoders are operating. Q7Tuner reception mode indicators This lights connections. Q6Decoder indicators This lights when the room equalizer is selected. This lights when AL24 Processing Plus is activated (vpage 63). Q4Input mode indicators Q5HDMI indicator uMaster volume indicator iAUDYSSEY MULTEQ XT indicator oRecording output source indicator r t Q3AL24 indicator These light when digital signals are input. eInformation display e These light according to the reception conditions when the input source is set to “TUNER”. •AUTO This lights when in the auto tuning mode. •RDS This lights when receiving RDS broadcasts. •STEREO In the FM mode, this lights when receiving analog stereo broadcasts. •TUNED This lights when the broadcast is properly tuned in. Q2RESTORER indicator This lights when the RESTORER mode is selected. 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 8 2007/09/28 11:40:12 ENGLISH Q1 Q2 Q0 Getting Started Rear Panel o Connections Setup Playback Q3 Q3 Q6 Remote Control Q5 Q5 Q4 Multi-Zone Information w e qRS-232C connector······································ (19) wREMOTE CONTROL jacks··························· (19) eTRIGGER OUT jacks···································· (19) rDOCK CONTROL jack·································· (14) tSpeaker terminals (SPEAKERS)··················· (9) ySIGNAL GND terminal································ (13) r t uAC inlet (AC IN)············································ (20) iAC OUTLET·················································· (20) oDigital audio connectors y u Troubleshooting q i Q2VIDEO / S-VIDEO connectors····················· (12) Q3Analog audio connectors (AUDIO)············· (12) Q4FM/AM antenna terminals (OPTICAL / COAXIAL)··························· (12, 15) (TUNER ANTENNA)····································· (18) Q0COMPONENT VIDEO connectors··············· (12) Q1HDMI connectors··········································(11) Q5PRE OUT connectors······························ (17, 19) Q6EXT. IN connectors······································ (17) 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 9 2007/09/28 11:40:15 ENGLISH Getting Started Remote Control Unit nMain remote control unit (RC-1068) Q5 Connections q Setup w Q6 Q7 Playback e r Remote Control Multi-Zone t y u i Q8 Q9 o W2 W0 W1 Information Q0 W3 Q1 W4 Q2 Troubleshooting Q3 W5 W6 Q4 W7 nSub remote control unit (RC-1071) qSignal transmission indicator···················· (51) wMode select buttons··································· (51) eQuick select / System call buttons······ (50, 55) rSurround mode buttons·····················(36 ~ 38) tSystem buttons····································· (52, 53) yAudio delay button (A. DL)························· (41) uTuner system buttons································· (44) iInput mode button (INPUT)························ (34) oMENU button··············································· (20) Q0Cursor buttons (uio p)·························· (20) Q1Parameter / Search button (PARA / SRCH)······································· (38, 48) Q2HOME button··············································· (51) Q3Channel buttons (CH)·································· (44) Q4Input source select / Number buttons··· (43, 44) Q5Remote control signal transmitter··············· (3) Q6Device select indicators (DEV1 / DEV2)···· (51) Q7ZONE3 select indicators (Z3)······················ (51) Q8RESTORER button (RSTR)··························· (41) Q9Night button (NGT)····································· (41) W0Test tone button (TEST)······························ (27) W1Front speaker select button (SPKR)··········· (43) W2POWER buttons··········································· (43) W3Channel select (CH SEL) / ENTER button········································ (20, 49) W4Return button (RTN)···································· (20) W5Master volume control buttons (VOL)······· (43) W6Muting button (MUTE)·························· (43, 60) W7Main remote control unit setup button (RC SETUP)·················································· (51) The time for which the backlight stays on can be changed (vpage 55 “Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit”). q i w o NOTE •The M. SEL, SAT TU, DTU, NET/USB buttons cannot be used. •The ZONE2 mode QUICK SELECT (1 ~ 3), A. DL, RSTR, NGT, INPUT, SPKR, TEST and surround mode buttons cannot be used. •The ZONE4 mode cannot be used. Q0 Q1 e r t Q2 Q3 y u qRemote control signal transmitter··············· (3) wZone power off button (OFF)······················ (60) eCHANNEL buttons······································· (57) rTUNING buttons·········································· (57) tSystem buttons··········································· (57) yREPEAT button············································· (57) uRANDOM button········································· (57) iZONE2/ZONE3 select switch······················ (57) oZone power on button (ON)······················· (60) Q0Input source select buttons························ (60) Q1Volume control buttons (VOLUME)··········· (60) Q2Muting button (MUTE)································ (60) Q3SHIFT button················································ (57) The FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY button is for future use. NOTE The SAT TU and DTU buttons cannot be used. 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 10 2007/09/28 11:40:16 ENGLISH Connections Cables Used for Connections Select the cables according to the equipment being connected. Audio cables Component video connections (Green) (Orange) Coaxial digital (75 Ω/ohms pin-plug) cable (Red) (PR/CR) Component video cable S-Video connections Optical cable (White) L L (Red) R R S-Video cable Video connections (Yellow) Multi-Zone Stereo pin-plug cable 75 Ω/ohms pin-plug video cable Analog connections (monaural, for subwoofer) (Black) Audio and video cables Information Pin-plug cable Remote Control Analog connections (stereo) (PB/CB) Playback Optical digital connections (Y) (Blue) Setup •Do not plug in the power cord until all connections have been completed. •When making connections, also refer to the operating instructions of the other components. •Be sure to connect the left and right channels properly (left with left, right with right). •Do not bundle power cords together with connection cables. Doing so can result in humming or noise. Video cables Coaxial digital connections NOTE Connections Connections for all compatible audio and video signal formats are described in these operating instructions. Please select the types of connections suited for the equipment you are connecting. With some types of connections, certain settings must be made on the AVR-2808. For details, refer to the instructions for the respective connection items below. Getting Started Preparations HDMI connections Speaker connections Speaker cables Troubleshooting 19-pin HDMI cable Signal direction Audio signal: Video signal: Output Input Input Output Output Input Input Output 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 11 2007/09/28 11:40:17 ENGLISH Getting Started Video Conversion Function Connections •This function automatically converts various formats of video signals input to the AVR-2808 into the format used to output the video signals from the AVR-2808 to a monitor. •The AVR-2808’s video input/output circuitry is compatible with the following four types of video signals: Digital video signals: HDMI Analog video signals: Component video, S-Video and Video GFlow of video signals inside the AVR-2808H Setup HDMI connector Component video connectors Component video connectors S-Video connector S-Video connector Video connector Video connector Video inputs Video outputs Playback HDMI connector NOTE •HDMI signals cannot be converted into analog signals. •1080p component input video signals cannot be output to anything other than component video connectors. •480p/576p, 1080i and 720p component video input signals cannot be converted into S-Video or Video format. •When a non-standard video signal from a game machine or some other source is input, the video conversion function might not operate. Main zone High picture quality playback •When not using this function, connect a monitor output with the same type of connector as the video input connector. •The resolution of the HDMI input-compatible monitor connected to the AVR-2808 can be checked at menu “Information” – “HDMI Information” (vpage 42). Remote Control Monitor On-Screen Display for Component Video Outputs and HDMI Output Multi-Zone •When viewing HDMI or component video signals via the AVR-2808, the on-screen display appears when the MENU button or the main remote control unit´s PARA button is operated. •When only HDMI or component video signals are input to the AVR-2808, the characters of the on-screen display are not displayed over the picture. Information : When 480i/576i signals are input in the main zone GFlow of video signals for ZONE2H Troubleshooting ZONE2 High picture quality playback ZONE2 monitor S-Video connector Video connector Video connector Video inputs Video outputs 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 12 2007/09/28 11:40:18 ENGLISH Speaker Connections Getting Started Speaker Connections Example: 7.1-channels (FRONT A+B) Speaker Installation Front speakers A Front speakers B Center speaker Subwoofer (L) w (R) q w (L) q w (R) q w q w q */ Setup Subwoofer with built-in amplifier Surround back speakers Connections The illustration below shows a basic example of installation of the amplifier combined with 8 speakers and a monitor. Subwoofer Center speaker Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Front speakers Place the front speakers to the sides of the monitor or screen and as flush with the screen surface as possible. Surround speakers Information The table below shows a typical speaker configuration for the AVR-2808. 7.1-channels (FRONT A+B) 7.1-channels 6.1-channels 5.1-channels 3.1-channels 2.1-channels 2-channels CENTER SURROUND L R SURROUND BACK SUBWOOFER L R 1 only S S S S S S S – S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S – – S S S – – – S S S – – – S – – – – – S – – – – – – S – – – – S S S S S – bL : Left R : Right (L) w (R) qw (L) q Surround speakers w Troubleshooting FRONT L R (R) qw q Surround back speakers When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL). 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 13 2007/09/28 11:40:21 ENGLISH Getting Started Connecting the Speaker Cables Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and + (red) and – (black) polarities on the speakers being connected to the AVR-2808, and be sure to interconnect the channels and polarities correctly. Connections 1 Peel off about 10 mm of sheathing from Setup Playback Remote Control 2 3 4 the tip of the speaker cable, then either twist the core wire tightly or terminate it. Turn the speaker terminal counterclockwise to loosen it. Insert the speaker cable’s core wire to Protection circuit If speakers with an impedance lower than specified (for example 4 Ω/ohms speakers) are used for an extended period of time with the volume turned up high, the temperature may rise, activating the protection circuit. When the protection circuit is activated, the speaker output is shut off and the power indicator flashes red. If this happens, unplug the power cord, then check the speaker cable and input cable connections. If the set is extremely hot, wait for it to cool off and improve ventilation around it. Once this is done, plug the power cord back in and turn the set’s power back on. If the protection circuit is activated again even though there are no problems in the ventilation around the set nor in the connections, the set may be damaged. Turn the power off, then contact a DENON service center. the hilt into the speaker terminal. Turn the speaker terminal clockwise to tighten it. NOTE Multi-Zone Information •Use speakers with an impedance of 6 to 16 Ω/ohms. When using front A and B speakers simultaneously, use speakers with an impedance of 8 to 16 Ω/ohms. •Connect the speaker cables in such a way that they do not stick out of the speaker terminals. The protection circuit may be activated if the core wires touch the rear panel or if the + and – sides touch each other (v “Protection circuit”). •Never touch the speaker terminals while the power supply is connected. Doing so could result in electric shock. Troubleshooting 10 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 14 2007/09/28 11:40:22 ENGLISH NOTE With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable. Monitor )%.* 065 )%.* */ bThe AVR-2808 is equipped for HDMI version 1.3a. This version is compatible with other versions, allowing connection to all components equipped with an HDMI connector. bThe AVR-2808 is compatible with 30- and 36-bit Deep Color. Details Discs (examples) 2ch 32-192 kHz 16/20/24 bits CD, DVD-Video, DVD-Audio Multi-channel linear PCM 8ch 32-192 kHz 16/20/24 bits DVD-Audio DSD 2/5.1ch 2.8224 MHz 1 bit SACD HD DVD, Blu-ray Disc •When the AVR-2808 and DVD player are connected using an HDMI cable, also connect the AVR-2808 and monitor using an HDMI cable. •If the connected monitor or DVD player only has a DVI-D connector, use an HDMI/DVI converter cable. When using a DVI cable, no audio signals are transmitted. •Use a Deep Color compatible cable for connection to Deep Color compatible devices. When connecting with an HDMI/DVI converter cable (adapter) Copyright protection system (HDCP) Information Troubleshooting In order to play the digital video and audio signals of a DVDVideo or DVD-Audio disc using HDMI/DVI connections, both the connected DVD player and monitor must be equipped for a copyright protection system called “HDCP” (Highbandwidth Digital Content Protection). HDCP is a copy protection technology consisting of data encoding and mutual identification of the devices. The AVR-2808 is HDCP-compatible. For details on the DVD player or monitor you are using, refer to its operating instructions. •HDMI video signals are theoretically compatible with the DVI format. When connecting to a monitor, etc., equipped with a DVI-D connector, connection is possible using an HDMI/DVI converter cable, but depending on the combination of components in some cases the video signals will not be output. •When connecting using an HDMI/DVI converter adapter, the video signals may not be output properly due to poor connections with the connected cable, etc. Multi-Zone Dolby Digital Plus, Dolby TrueHD, Bitstream DTS-HD DVD-Video Remote Control Dolby Digital, DTS Bitstream Playback 2-channel linear PCM Setup Compatible audio format Connections DVD player •Use a CPPM-compatible DVD player to play DVD-Audio discs that are copyright-protected by CPPM. •The AVR-2808 cannot be controlled from another device via the HDMI cable. •The audio signals output from the HDMI connector (sampling frequency, bit rate, etc.) may be restricted by the connected device. •Video signals are not output properly when using devices that are not HDCP-compatible. •Video signals are not output if the input video signals do not match the monitor’s resolution. In this case, switch the DVD player’s resolution to a resolution with which the monitor is compatible. •If the menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” setting (vpage 27) is set to “AMP”, the sound may be interrupted when the monitor’s power is turned off. •Use a cable on which the HDMI logo is indicated (a certified HDMI product) for connection to the HDMI connector. Normal playback may not be possible when using a cable other than one on which the HDMI logo is indicated (a non-HDMI-certified product). •If the monitor or DVD player does not support deep color, deep color signal transfer is not possible. •If the monitor or DVD player does not support xvYCC, xvYCC signal transfer is not possible. •If the monitor does not support “Auto Lipsync Correction” function, this function will not work. Getting Started Connecting Equipment with HDMI connectors •By default, the HDMI audio signals are output from the speakers connected to the AVR-2808. •To output the sound from the TV, make the settings at menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” – “TV” (vpage 27). 11 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 15 2007/09/28 11:40:23 ENGLISH Getting Started Connecting the Monitor Connecting the Playback Components •Connect the cables to be used (vpage 8 “Video Conversion Function”). •With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable. •To output the audio signals to the monitor with HDMI connections, set menu “Manual Setup” – “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” to “TV” (vpage 27). Connections Monitor 7*%&0 )%.* */ 7*%&0 */ 47*%&0 */ $0.10/&/57*%&0 */ : 1# 13 Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly. DVD Player •Connect the cables to be used. •With HDMI connections, the video and audio signals can be transferred with a single cable. DVD player Setup 7*%&0 )%.* 065 7*%&0 065 47*%&0 065 $0.10/&/57*%&0 065 : 1# 13 "6%*0 "6%*0 065 3 Playback Remote Control L R L R $0"9*"065 Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting NOTE •The component video connectors may be indicated differently on your monitor. For details, see the monitor’s operating instructions. •The audio signals output from the HDMI connectors are only the HDMI input signals. •Connect an HDP (High-Definition Player) in the same way. •When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35). 12 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 16 2007/09/28 11:40:28 ENGLISH CD Player Turntable (MM cartridge) Getting Started Record Player Connect the cables to be used. CD player "6%*0 L R L R Setup "6%*0 065 $0"9*"065 Connections "6%*0 065 3 (/% L R Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting •When connecting a record player with an MC cartridge, use a commercially available MC head amplifier or a step-up transformer. •Induction humming (a booming sound) may be produced from the speakers if the volume is raised with no record player connected. •With some record players, noise may be generated when the ground wire is connected. If so, disconnect the ground wire. When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35). NOTE The AVR-2808’s SIGNAL GND terminal is meant to reduce noise when a record player is connected. This is not a safety ground terminal. 13 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 17 2007/09/28 11:40:31 ENGLISH Getting Started iPod® TV/CABLE Tuner Use a DENON Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R, sold separately) to connect the iPod to the AVR-2808. For instructions on the Control Dock for iPod settings, refer to the Control Dock for iPod’s operating instructions. Connect the cables to be used. TV tuner 7*%&0 Connections 7*%&0 065 iPod "4%3 47*%&0 065 $0.10/&/57*%&0 065 : 1# 13 "6%*0 "6%*0 065 3 R L R Setup L $0"9*"065 Playback Remote Control R L R L Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting When using an optical cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35). •With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector. •To assign the iPod to a connector other than VCR (iPod), make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “(input source to which iPod dock assigned)” – “Assign” – “iPod dock” (vpage 35). 14 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 18 2007/09/28 11:40:35 ENGLISH Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly. Connect the cables to be used. DBS / BS tuner 7*%&0 47*%&0 065 "6%*0 "6%*0 065 3 015*$"065 Digital Video Recorder Connections 7*%&0 065 Connect the cables to be used. Digital video recorder 7*%&0 L R "6%*0 "6%*0 */ - 065 */ Playback L 3 015*$"065 3 Setup 47*%&0 */ 065 7*%&0 065 */ R R L R L R L R or Remote Control L Getting Started Connecting the Recording Components Satellite Receiver or Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting •When using a coaxial digital cable for the digital audio connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Digital In” (vpage 35). •When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 35). •Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals. •When recording via the AVR-2808, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable used to connect the AVR-2808´s DVR OUT connector. Example: TV IN → S-Video cable : DVR OUT → S-Video cable TV IN → Video cable : DVR OUT → Video cable •When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 35). NOTE Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808’s OPTICAL2 output connector to any input connector other than OPTICAL2. 15 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 19 2007/09/28 11:40:41 ENGLISH Getting Started Video Cassette Recorder CD Recorder / MD Recorder / Tape Deck Connect the cables to be used. Make analog connections if you wish to record analog audio signals, or digital connections if you wish to record digital audio signals, depending on the types of connectors on the components being used. Video cassette recorder 7*%&0 Connections CD recorder / MD recorder / Tape deck "6%*0 47*%&0 */ 065 7*%&0 065 */ "6%*0 */ - 3 015*$"065 3 065 */ "6%*0 "6%*0 065 3 L R L 015*$"*/ - 065 */ 3 R Setup Playback or L R L R L R L R or L R L R or Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting •When recording via the AVR-2808, the playback device´s cable must be of the same type as the cable used to connect the AVR-2808´s VCR OUT connector. Example: TV IN → S-Video cable : VCR OUT → S-Video cable TV IN → Video cable : VCR OUT → Video cable •When using a component video cable for the video connection, make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Assign” – “Component In” (vpage 35). NOTE Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808’s OPTICAL3 output connector to any input connector other than OPTICAL3. NOTE Do not connect the output of the component connected to the AVR-2808’s OPTICAL3 output connector to any input connector other than OPTICAL3. 16 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 20 2007/09/28 11:40:46 ENGLISH Carefully check the left (L) and right (R) channels and the inputs and outputs, and be sure to interconnect correctly. Video camera / Game console 7*%&0 7*%&0 065 "6%*0 065 3 '30/5 - 463306/% - 3 3 $&/5&3 463306/% - 3 463306/% #"$, - 3 463306/% #"$, - 3 L R L R L R R L R L L R L R L R R Playback R L R L R L R Remote Control L '30/5 015*$"065 L L 3 $&/5&3 "6%*0 46# 800'&3 - "6%*0 46# 800'&3 Power amplifier Setup 47*%&0 065 "6%*0 DVD player / Super Audio CD player / External decoder External Power Amplifier Connections Video Camera / Game Console Component with Multi-channel Output connectors Getting Started Connections to Other Devices R Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting •To play the analog input signals input to the EXT. IN connectors, press the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or INPUT button on the main remote control unit and select “EXT. IN” or make the settings at menu “Input Setup” – “Input Mode” – “Input Mode” – “EXT. IN” (vpage 34). •The video signal can be connected in the same way as a DVD player (vpage 12). •To play copyright-protected discs, connect the AVR-2808’s EXT. IN connector with the DVD player’s analog multi-channel output connector. When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL). 17 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 21 2007/09/28 11:40:51 ENGLISH Getting Started Antenna terminals An FM antenna cable plug can be connected directly. Direction of broadcasting station Connections AM loop antenna (supplied) FM antenna Setup Playback 75 Ω/ohms Coaxial cable Remote Control FM indoor antenna (supplied) Multi-Zone Information Ground AM outdoor antenna Troubleshooting AM loop antenna assembly Connect to the AM antenna terminals. Remove the vinyl tie and take out the connection line. a.With the antenna on top of any stable surface. Mount Connection of AM antennas 1.Push the lever. 2.Insert the conductor. 3.Return the lever. Bend in the reverse direction. b.With the antenna attached to a wall. NOTE •Do not connect two FM antennas simultaneously. •Even if an external AM antenna is used, do not disconnect the AM loop antenna. •Make sure the AM loop antenna lead terminals do not touch metal parts of the panel. Installation hole Mount on wall, etc. 18 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 22 2007/09/28 11:40:53 ENGLISH External Controller Getting Started Multi-zone ZONE2 or ZONE3 Pre-out Connections 7*%&0 "6%*0 7*%&0 */ "6%*0 */ 3 R L R Infrared retransmitter Input Output Infrared sensor Troubleshooting "69 065 Information Trigger output jacks The power of an external device equipped with a trigger input jack can be turned on and off in association with operations on the AVR-2808. For details, see menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Trigger Out” (vpage 32). •Output: DC 12 V 150 mA MAX. Check the trigger input conditions of the connected device. Multi-Zone •When using in combination with an RF Remote Controller (RC-7000CI, sold separately) or RF Remote Receiver (RC-7001RCI, sold separately) two-way communication with an RF Remote Controller is possible. The AVR-2808’s status information as well as iPod can be browsed watching the RF Remote Controller’s display. For details, refer to the operating instructions of the respective devices. •When used in combination with an RF Remote Controller or RF Remote Receiver, make the settings at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “2Way Remote” – “Used” (vpage 32). Remote Control L b If you wish to control the AVR-2808 from an external controller using the RS-232C connector, perform the operation below beforehand. q Turn on the AVR-2808’s power. w Turn off the AVR-2808’s power from the external controller. e Check that the AVR-2808 is in the standby mode. Playback Power amplifier (ZONE2 or ZONE3) This connector is used for an external controller. Setup Monitor (ZONE2) RS-232C connector Connections •If another power amplifier or pre-main (integrated) amplifier is connected, the ZONE2 or ZONE3 pre-out (variable or fixed level) connectors can be used to play a different program source in ZONE2 or ZONE3 the same time (vpage 57 ~ 60). •When using an S-Video cable or a video cable for connection between the AVR-2808 and an input device, connect to the video connectors. •The ZONE2 video out is only for ZONE2. Extension jack for future use. NOTE •For the audio output, use high quality pin-plug cords so that no induction humming or noise is produced. •For instructions on installing and operating separately sold devices, refer to the respective devices’ operating instructions. •To conduct multi-zone playback, see “Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations” (vpage 57 ~ 60). 19 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 23 2007/09/28 11:40:57 ENGLISH Getting Started Connecting the Power Cord Wait until all connections have been completed before connecting the power cord. Menu Operations Connection to the AC outlet Connections •These outlets supply power to external audio devices. •The power supplied from this outlet turns on and off together with the set’s power switch. •Audio equipment with a total power consumption of 100 W (0.43 A) can be connected. Setup Playback Power cord (included) With the AVR-2808, settings and operations for most functions can be performed by operating while looking at the menus displayed on the monitor screen. uiop Operations RETURN The same operation is possible on the main unit or remote control unit. To household power outlet (AC 230 V, 50 Hz) Remote Control Multi-Zone Information 1 Press MENU. 2 3 4 Press ui to select the item you want The menu is displayed. bTo operate from the main remote control unit, be sure to set the remote control unit to the AMP mode. NOTE MENU •Insert the AC plugs securely. Incomplete connections could cause noise. •Only use the AC outlet to plug in audio devices. Do not use them as power supplies for hairdryers or anything other than audio equipment. ENTER to set, then press ENTER. Press ui again to select the item you [ AMP] want to set, then press ENTER. To change the setting: Once Connections are Completed Turning the Power On (vpage 43) Press ui to select the item you want to change, then press o p to change the setting. bTo return to the previous item, press RETURN. Troubleshooting bSelect “Default Yes”, then press o to reset to the default setting. MENU ENTER uiop RETURN About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit 5 6 Press ENTER to enter the setting. Press MENU to finish. When MENU is pressed, the settings made up to that point are entered and the settings menu screen turns off. 20 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 24 2007/09/28 11:40:59 ENGLISH Some typical examples are described below. GFront displayH GOn-screen displayH Screen title MENU *MENU Auto Setup [Selectable items] A Submenu title B A+B Connections In lists of selectable items or adjustable ranges, the item surrounded by a border is the default value. Examples of On-screen Display and Front Display Getting Started Example of Display of Default Values 1.Auto Setup 2.Manual Setup 3.Input Setup 4.Parameter 5.Information Setup Press o to execute Currently selected line Current setting Press op to change the setting 3-1.Assign Digital In : OPT1 iPod dock : None Multi-Zone *Assign Digital :•OPT1 – Front Sp. A Amp Assign Start Cancel Information 2-1-3.Distance *Distance Unit:Meter•–Feet Set The Distance To Each Speakers Do You Prefer In Meters? / In Feet? Meters *Rename:DVD •DV¡ – Use ui to input characters. Use op to change the character input position. : Feet 3-3.Rename DVD Troubleshooting Press op to select one or the other Remote Control 1-1.Start Menu Audyssey MultEQ XT Step1:Speaker Detection Please place microphone at ear height at main listening position. Playback *Start Menu Start• : DV Default Yes 3-3.Rename *Rename:DVD Rename•– Clear When highlighted, press i to select “Default Yes”. DVD : DVD-3930 Default Yes 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 25 2007/09/28 11:41:01 ENGLISH Getting Started Menu Map Auto Setup (vpage 23 ~ 25) MENU n Start Menu • Step 1: Speaker Detection • Step 2: Measurement • Step 3: Calculation • Step 4: Check • Step 5: Store Connections 1.Auto Setup 2.Manual Setup 3.Input Setup 4.Parameter 5.Information n Option • Room EQ • Direct Mode Setup • Mic Select Setup n Parameter Check • Speaker Configuration Check • Distance Check • Channel Level Check • Crossover Frequency Check • EQ Check • Restore Playback Manual Setup (vpage 26 ~ 33) Remote Control Information (vpage 41, 42) Multi-Zone Information n Status • Main Zone • ZONE2/ZONE3 n Audio Input Signal n HDMI Information n Auto Surround Mode n Quick Select n Preset Station Troubleshooting When “Screensaver” is set to “ON”, the screensaver is activated if no operation is performed for about 3 minutes. When the uiop, ENTER or MENU button is pressed, the screensaver is canceled and the corresponding operation is performed. n Speaker Setup (vpage 26, 27) • Speaker Configuration • Subwoofer Setup • Distance • Channel Level • Crossover Frequency n HDMI Setup (vpage 27, 28) • HDMI Audio Setup · HDMI Audio Out · Auto Lipsync • HDMI Video Setup · i/p Scaler · Resolution · Progressive Mode · Aspect · Color Space · RGB Range n Audio Setup (vpage 28, 29) • EXT. IN Subwoofer Level • 2ch Direct/Stereo • Dolby Digital Setup • Auto Surround Mode • Manual EQ Parameter (vpage 38 ~ 41) n Surround Parameter • MODE • CINEMA EQ • D.COMP • DRC • LFE • CENTER IMAGE • PANORAMA • DIMENSION • CENTER WIDTH • DELAY TIME • EFFECT • LEVEL • ROOM SIZE • AFDM • SB CH OUT • SW ATT • Subwoofer • Default n Tone Control • Tone Defeat • Bass • Treble n Room EQ n RESTORER n Night Mode n Audio Delay n Zone Setup (vpage 30) • ZONE2 Setup · Bass · Treble · HPF · Lch Level · Rch Level · Channel · Volume Level · Volume Limit · Power On Level · Mute Level • ZONE3 Setup · Bass · Treble · HPF · Lch Level · Rch Level · Channel · Volume Level · Volume Limit · Power On Level · Mute Level n Option Setup (vpage 31 ~ 33) • Amp Assign • Volume Control · Volume Limit · Power On Level · Mute Level • Source Delete • On-Screen Display · Screensaver · Text · Master Volume · Tuner Information · iPod Information · Display Mode • Quick Select Name • Trigger Out • Remote ID Setup • 2Way Remote • Display • Setup Lock Input Setup (vpage 33 ~ 36) n TUNER (FM/AM) • Auto Preset • Preset Skip • Preset Name • Input Mode • Rename • Other · Video Select · Source Level n PHONO • Input Mode • Rename • Other · Video Select · Source Level n CD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL, SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX • Assign • Input Mode • Rename • Other · Video Select · Video Convert (Excluding CDs) · Source Level • iPod 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 26 2007/09/28 11:41:17 ENGLISH 1 Getting Started Preparations Connect the included calibrated setup microphone to Auto Setup Sound receptor Setup 2 Place the microphone at ear height on a tripod or stand Playback with the microphone pointing directly up towards the ceiling. Remote Control Example q The auto setup screen appears automatically. Connections •Audyssey MultEQ® XT automatically measures the acoustical problems in the listening environment to create the best audio experience for your home theater. •It optimizes a large listening area where one or more listeners are seated. Measurements are performed by placing the calibrated microphone (DM-A405) successively at multiple positions throughout the listening area as shown in Example q. For best results, it is strongly recommended to measure 6 or more positions so that the measurements have the proper spatial weighting. Even if the listening environment is small as shown in Example w, measuring at multiple points throughout the listening environment results in more effective correction. the SETUP MIC jack on the main unit. Example w Multi-Zone Setup microphone ( :Measuring positions) *M The main listening position refers to the most central position where one would normally sit within the listening environment. MultEQ XT uses the measurements from this position to calculate speaker distance, level, polarity, and the optimum crossover value for the subwoofer. To make manual adjustments to the settings, see pages 26, 27. bIt is not recommended to hold it in your hand. Be sure that the path from microphone to the speakers is not blocked by objects. Avoid placing the microphone close to a seat back or wall as sound reflections may give inaccurate results. Troubleshooting About the main listening position (*M) Information *M When using a subwoofer, make the following settings before starting the auto setup procedure: •Defeat the volume and crossover controls if possible •If this is not possible then set • Volume: “12 o’clock” position • Crossover frequency: “Maximum/Highest Frequency” • Low pass filter: “Off” • Standby mode: “Off” NOTE •Do not disconnect the setup microphone until the auto setup procedure is completed. •When using headphones, unplug the headphones before starting the auto setup procedure. 23 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 27 2007/09/28 11:41:18 ENGLISH Getting Started Auto Setup Step 1 : Speaker Detection Optimize settings for speakers in use. F Menu screen F Connections 1-1.Start Menu Audyssey MultEQ XT Step1:Speaker Detection Please place microphone at ear height at main listening position. Setup Front Sp. A Amp Assign Start Cancel Playback a Start Menu The settings are performed automatically. Remote Control Start Multi-Zone Start Auto Setup. The Audyssey MultEQ XT Auto Setup process automatically calculates the size, level, distance, bass management crossover frequency, and optimal settings for each speaker and subwoofer. Audyssey MultEQ XT corrects acoustical distortions within the listening area. Before starting, connect and position all your speakers. Once started, MultEQ XT will play a series of test tones through each speaker. Information If an error message appears during the measurements, check “Error Messages”, take the advised action, then start the measurements again (vpage 25). Troubleshooting Front Speaker The speaker connection and polarity are detected at the fi rst measurement position. The following attributes are also determined at this time: “Speaker Size”, “Speaker Distance”, “Channel Level”, “Crossover Frequency”. Once the measurements are completed, the results are displayed. NOTE • Loud test tone may be played during Audyssey MultEQ XT Automatic Speaker Setup. This is part of normal operation. If there is background noise in room, these test tones will increase in volume. • Do not stand between the speakers and setup microphone or allow obstacles in the path while the measurements are being made. This will cause inaccurate readings. • Quiet the listening environment before beginning measurements and refrain from talking. Turn off air conditioning units or other devices that emit noise if at all possible as measurements may be affected by these sounds. • Operating the MASTER VOLUME knob on the main unit or the VOL +/– buttons on the remote control unit during the measurements will cancel the measurements. • Do not change the speaker connections or subwoofer volume after “Step 1”. Step 2 : Measurement After completing a measurement position, move the microphone to the next position. Step 3 : Calculation When “Calculate” is selected at “Step 2”, the measurements taken are analyzed automatically to determine how the speaker system interacts with the room. The time required for this analysis depends on the number of speakers connected. The higher the number of speakers, the longer the time required for analysis. Step 4 : Check Once the auto setup procedure is complete, a measuring result check screen appears. Select any item whose results you want to check to review the results. Values that are different from the actual distance may be set for speakers with built-in filters (subwoofers, etc.). This is because filters add electrical delay to the signal that should be compensated. Step 5 : Store The auto setup measurement results are stored in the AVR-2808. NOTE Do not turn the power off while the settings are being stored. Measure at least 6 positions (main listening position and at least 5 other surrounding positions). For best results it is recommend measuring 6 or more positions (with a maximum of 8 positions). The front speaker to be measured can be selected ahead of time here. [Selectable items] A : Output test tone from front speakers A. B : Output test tone from front speakers B. A + B : Output test tone from front speakers A and B. Amp Assign Advanced setting : changes power amplifier assignment. For details, refer to “Amp Assign” (vpage 31). 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 28 2007/09/28 11:41:21 ENGLISH sOption If the auto setup procedure could not be completed due to speaker installation, the measuring environment, etc., an error message is displayed. If this happens, check the relevant items, be sure to take the necessary measures, then perform the auto setup procedure over again. Select settings for room EQ, mic, etc. Measures [Selectable items] All :Apply settings to all surround modes. Assign :Make settings for each surround mode separately. Playback Direct Mode Setup Retry Cancel Select room EQ use for DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode. •Too much noise in the room for accurate •Either turn off any device generating noise or move it measurements to be made. away. •Try again when the surroundings are quieter. •Speaker or subwoofer sound is too low for •Check the speaker installation and the direction in accurate measurements to be made. which the speakers are facing. •Adjust the subwoofer’s volume. [Selectable items] ON :Use room EQ. OFF :Do not use room EQ. Remote Control Auto Setup Audyssey MultEQ XT Caution! Ambient noise is too high or Level is too low. Select room EQ setting method. Setup Auto Setup Audyssey MultEQ XT Caution! Microphone:None or Speaker :None Cause •Included setup microphone is not connected. •Connect the included setup microphone to the SETUP MIC jack on the main unit. •Check the speaker connections. •Not all speakers could be detected. Room EQ Connections Error messages (examples) Getting Started Error Messages Mic Select Retry Cancel R :None Retry Cancel Front L :Phase Retry Cancel Skip Mic :Supplied mic is being used. V.AUX L :Other mic connected to V.AUX is used. Only a professionally certified installer should ever connect a professionally-calibrated microphone to the V.AUX L input on the front panel. dParameter Check Troubleshooting Auto Setup Audyssey MultEQ XT Caution! [Selectable items] Information Front Select the microphone type if not using supplied mic. The microphone connected to V.AUX Lch is used. Multi-Zone Auto Setup Audyssey MultEQ XT Caution! •Displayed speaker could not be detected. •Check the connections of the displayed speaker. · The front L and front R speakers were not properly detected. · Only one channel of the surround speakers was detected. · Sound was output from the R channel when only one surround back speaker was connected. · The surround back speaker was detected, but the surround speaker was not detected. •Displayed speaker connected with the •Check the polarities of the displayed speaker. polarities reversed. •For some speakers, this error message may be displayed even if the speaker is properly connected. If you are sure that the wiring is correct, select “Skip”. Check auto setup measurement results. This is displayed after the auto setup procedure is completed. [Items to be checked] Select “Retry” to make the measurements again. NOTE Be sure to turn the power off before checking the speaker connections. Speaker Config. Check Distance Check Channel Level Check Crossover Freq. Check EQ Check The auto setup results can be reset to what was originally calculated by MultEQ XT when “Restore” is selected. 25 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 29 2007/09/28 11:41:21 ENGLISH Getting Started Surround Speaker sSubwoofer Setup Select surround speakers use and size. [Selectable items] Large Manual Setup Small Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer. None Connections LFE Surround Back Speaker Make detail settings for various parameters. Select surround back speaker use and size. [Selectable items] Large Speaker Setup Setup Use this procedure to set the speakers manually or if you wish to change the settings made with the auto setup procedure. Playback F Menu screen F 2spkrs Small None frequency reproduction capabilities. 2.Manual Setup Remote Control 1.Auto Setup 2.Manual Setup 3.Input Setup 4.Parameter 5.Information 1.Speaker Setup 2.HDMI Setup 3.Audio Setup 4.Zone Setup 5.Option Setup Multi-Zone aSpeaker Configuration Information Select speaker configuration and size. (bass reproduction capability) Troubleshooting Select front speaker size. Small Center Speaker Select center speaker use and size. [Selectable items] Large Small Subwoofer LFE+Main :Play low range and LFE signal of all channels. Small :Select this when using small speakers without ample low frequency reproduction capabilities. •This can be set when menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Subwoofer” is set to “Yes”. •Play music or a movie source and select the mode offering the strongest bass. •Select “LFE+Main” if you want the bass signals to always be produced from the subwoofer. None :Select this when no speaker is connected. Yes :Select this when a subwoofer is connected. No :Select this when no subwoofer is connected. 2spkrs 1spkr : Select the number of surround back speakers. dDistance Set distance from listening position to speakers. Before making the settings, measure the distance from the listening position to the different speakers. Meters / Feet Select unit for distance. Front Speaker [Selectable items] Large :Play low range and LFE signal of channels set to “Small”. 1spkr Large :Select this when using large speakers with ample low MENU [Selectable items] None •Select “Large” or “Small” not according to the physical size of the speaker but according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities based on the frequency set at “Crossover Frequency” (vpage 27). •When “Front Speaker” is set to “Small”,“Subwoofer” is automatically set to “Yes”. •If “Subwoofer” is set to “No”, “Front Speaker” is automatically set to “Large”. •If “Surround Speaker” is set to “None”, “Surround Back Speaker” are automatically set to “None”. •When using just one surround back speaker, connect it to the left channel (SBL). Step Select step. (smallest distance) [Selectable items] 0.1m 1ft 0.01m :Can be selected when “Meters” is set. 0.1ft :Can be selected when “Feet” is set. Default Resets the settings to the default values. Select subwoofer use. [Selectable items] Yes No 26 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 30 2007/09/28 11:41:22 ENGLISH Distance measurement [Variable range] 0.0ft ~ 60.0ft :Display when “Feet” is set. NOTE Select test tone playback method. Auto :Automatically switch speaker from which test tone is output. Manual :Manually switch speaker from which test tone is output. [Selectable items] 40Hz 60Hz 200Hz 250Hz : 80Hz 90Hz 100Hz 110Hz 120Hz 150Hz Only the portion of the bass sound of the various speakers output from the subwoofer that has a frequency below the frequency set here is output. Set this according to the low frequency reproduction capabilities of the speakers you are using. HDMI Audio Out Select HDMI audio output device. [Selectable items] AMP :Use speakers connected to receiver for audio playback. TV :Use speakers of monitor for audio playback. Advanced : ~ +12dB Default Resets the settings to the default values. Operating from the main remote control unit Adjusting with the main remote control unit using the test tones is only possible in the “Auto” mode and only effective in the STANDARD (Dolby/DTS Surround) mode. The adjusted levels for the different modes are automatically stored in the memory. •The “Crossover Frequency” can be set when there are speakers that have been set to “Small” at menu “Speaker Configuration” or when “Subwoofer” is set to “Yes” (vpage 26). •At the “Advanced” settings, if the menu “Subwoofer Setup” setting is set to “LFE”, speakers for which “Speaker Configuration” is set to “Small” can be set. If set to “LFE+Main”, the setting can be made regardless of the speaker size. •For speakers set to “Small”, sound below the crossover frequency is cut from the sound output. The cut bass sound is output from the subwoofer or front speakers. •Always set the crossover frequency to “80 Hz”. When using small speakers, however, we recommend setting the crossover frequency to a higher frequency. [Selectable items] ON :Use automatic compensation. OFF :Do not use automatic compensation. Troubleshooting 0dB Information Auto Lipsync Automatic compensation for timing shift in audio and video output. Output test tone. [Variable range] –12dB ~ aHDMI Audio Setup Make settings for HDMI audio output. Set the crossover frequency separately for the different speakers. Test Tone Start 1.HDMI Audio Setup 2.HDMI Video Setup Multi-Zone [Selectable items] 2-2.HDMI Setup Remote Control Test Tone 1.Speaker Setup 2.HDMI Setup 3.Audio Setup 4.Zone Setup 5.Option Setup Playback Adjust channel levels to obtain equal volume from all speakers. 2.Manual Setup gCrossover Frequency Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low range signal. fChannel Level F Menu screen F Setup Set the distance between the listening position and the various speakers to no more than 6.00 meters (20.0 ft). Make settings for HDMI video/audio output. Connections 0.00m ~ 18.00m :Display when “Meters” is set. HDMI Setup •When the menu “Speaker Configuration” – “Surround Back Speaker” setting (vpage 26) is set to “1spkr”, the surround back speaker display is set to “Surround Back Speaker”. •Speakers set to “None” in the “Speaker Configuration” settings are not displayed. •When “Channel Level” is adjusted, the adjusted values are set for all the surround modes. To adjust the channel level separately for the different surround modes, use the operation see page 49. Getting Started Select the speaker you want to set, then set the distance. Set the value closest to the measured distance. GAdjusting using test tonesH q Press the TEST button. Test tones are output from the various speakers. w Use the o p button to adjust so that the volume is equal for all speakers. e When the adjustments are completed, press the TEST button again. 27 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 31 2007/09/28 11:41:23 ENGLISH Getting Started sHDMI Video Setup Make settings for HDMI video output. i/p Scaler Connections Make settings for i/p scaler function. [Selectable items] Aspect This sets the aspect ratio when outputting 480i/576i or 480p/576p input signals from the HDMI output connector. [Selectable items] FULL :Output at 16:9 aspect ratio. NORMAL :Output at 4:3 aspect ratio. A to H :Use i/p scaler function for analog video signal. Setup OFF :Do not use i/p scaler function. Playback Resolution Make settings for resolution of HDMI video output signal. [Selectable items] Remote Control Auto :Detect monitor panel resolution and automatically set output resolution. Multi-Zone :Output at 1080i resolution. 720p :Output at 720p resolution. 1080p :Output at 1080p resolution. Make settings for audio playback. F Menu screen F 2.Manual Setup 1.Speaker Setup 2.HDMI Setup 3.Audio Setup 4.Zone Setup 5.Option Setup 2-3.Audio Setup 1.EXT.IN SW Level 2.2ch Direct/Stereo 3.Dolby Digital Setup 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Manual EQ This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”. Color Space Make settings for output color space. [Selectable items] YCbCr RGB :Output using YCbCr format. :Output using RGB format. aEXT. IN Subwoofer Level Set the subwoofer level for playback. [Selectable items] 0dB 480p/576p :Output at 480p/576p resolution. 1080i Audio Setup +5dB +10dB : Select according to the player in use. When connected to a monitor with a DVI-D connector (HDCP compatible) using an HDMI/DVI converter cable, the signals are output in RGB format, regardless of this setting. +15dB : This is the recommended level. RGB Range Information This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”. NOTE Troubleshooting •It is not possible to convert “1080i” signals into “720p” format. •It is not possible to convert “720p” signals into “1080i” format. Progressive Mode Make settings for RGB output range. s2ch Direct/Stereo [Selectable items] Make speaker settings for 2-channel mode playback. Normal :Use video range from 16 (black) to 235 (white). Enhanced :Video range from 0 (black) to 255 (white). Use this setting to avoid black washout. Auto :Automatically detect video material type. Video1 :Select mode suitable for video playback. Video2 :Select mode suitable for video and 30-frame film material playback. To change the settings, select “Custom”. [Selectable items] Select optimum progressive mode for video material. [Selectable items] Setting When “YCbCr” is selected under “Color Space”, “RGB Range” will have no effect. Basic :Use the same settings as in “Speaker Setup”. Custom :Make separate settings for 2-channel mode. This can be set when “i/p Scaler” is set to “A to H”. 28 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 32 2007/09/28 11:41:24 ENGLISH Select front speaker size. [Selectable items] Large dDolby Digital Setup gManual EQ Set dynamic range for downmix playback of Dolby Digital sources. Adjust tonal quality for each speaker using graphic equalizer. [Selectable items] Small :Select front speaker size. Select subwoofer use. ON :Compression is used. Select this if sound from front speakers is distorted. OFF :Do not use compression. This is the recommended setting. Base Curve Copy Copy the Room EQ’s “Audyssey Flat” correction curve. [Selectable items] Yes Connections Subwoofer Getting Started Front No Yes No :Select subwoofer use. Subwoofer Mode Select low range signal to be reproduced by subwoofer. [Selectable items] Select speaker adjustment method. [Selectable items] LFE+Main :Select subwoofer signal. fAuto Surround Mode Make setting for memorizing surround mode setting for each input signal type. Crossover [Selectable items] ON [Selectable items] 60Hz 90Hz 100Hz 110Hz 200Hz 250Hz :Select crossover frequency. 120Hz Distance FL [Variable range] 0.00m ~ 18.00m Distance FR Set distance from listening position to front right speaker. [Variable range] 0.00m ~ 18.00m OFF :Do not memorize settings. Surround mode does not change according to input signal. •The auto surround mode function lets you store in the memory the surround mode last used for playing the four types of input signals listed below. qAnalog and PCM 2-channel signals wDolby Digital and DTS 2-channel signals eDolby Digital and DTS multi-channel signals rMulti-channel signals other than Dolby Digital and DTS (PCM, DSD, etc.) •When playing in the PURE DIRECT mode, the surround mode does not change even if the input signal is changed. ALL CH :Adjust tonal quality for all speakers together. Manual EQ Select the speaker and frequency band and adjust the level. [Selectable items] 63Hz 125Hz [Variable range] 2kHz 4kHz 20dB ~ 250Hz 8kHz 0dB ~ 500Hz 1kHz 16kHz +6dB Troubleshooting Set distance from listening position to front left speaker. 150Hz L/R CH :Adjust tonal quality for each L/R speaker pair. Information 40Hz :Memorize settings. Most recently stored surround mode is automatically selected. Each CH :Adjust tonal quality for each speaker separately. Multi-Zone Select crossover frequency from which subwoofer handles low range signal. 80Hz Adjust CH Remote Control LFE “Base Curve Copy” is displayed after the auto setup procedure has been performed. Playback •Set this to “ON” if the sound from the front speakers seems distorted. •When not using the center speaker or surround speakers, the playback sound is down-mixed and output from the front speakers. Setup [Selectable items] Default Resets the settings to the default values. 29 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 33 2007/09/28 11:41:24 ENGLISH Getting Started Zone Setup Lch Level Volume Limit Make settings for audio playback in a multi-zone system. Adjust the left channel output level. Make a setting for maximum volume. F Menu screen F [Variable range] –12dB ~ 0dB ~ +12dB 2.Manual Setup 2-4.Zone Setup Connections 1.Speaker Setup 2.HDMI Setup 3.Audio Setup 4.Zone Setup 5.Option Setup 1.ZONE2 Setup 2.ZONE3 Setup OFF Rch Level 0dB ~ +12dB Setup Channel Switch between stereo and mono output. Playback [Selectable items] aZONE2 Setup Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE2 system. Remote Control sZONE3 Setup Stereo :Select stereo output. Multi-Zone Adjust low frequency range (bass). Information Treble [Variable range] –10dB ~ 0dB When menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31) is set to ZONE2/3-MONO”, the “Channel” setting is automatically set to “Mono”. ~ +10dB [Variable range] –10dB ~ 0dB Troubleshooting When using speakers that cannot satisfactorily play low frequencies, distortion of the bass sound can be reduced by setting “HPF” to “ON”. [Selectable items] OFF :The low range is not attenuated. ON :The low range is attenuated. Power On Level Define the volume setting that is active when the power is turned on. [Selectable items] Last :Use the memorized setting from the last session. ––– :Always use the muting on condition when power is turned on. –70dB ~ +18dB :Set the volume level when the power is turned on in units of 1 dB. Mute Level Adjust the main volume level. [Selectable items] :Allow volume adjustment by remote control. –40dB :Fix the volume to –40 dB. 0dB HPF :Set the maximum volume to 0 dB. Set the amount of attenuation when muting is on. VAR ~ +10dB 0dB Volume Level [Selectable items] Adjust high frequency range (treble). –10dB :Set the maximum volume to –10 dB. Mono :Select monaural output. Make settings for audio playback in a ZONE3 system. Bass :Do not set a maximum volume. –20dB :Set the maximum volume to –20 dB. Adjust the right channel output level. [Variable range] –12dB ~ [Selectable items] Full :The sound is cut off entirely. –40dB :The sound is attenuated by 40 dB. –20dB :The sound is attenuated by 20 dB. :Fix the volume to 0 dB. “VAR” is displayed when a power amplifier is assigned to the ZONE2 output channel at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31). 30 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 34 2007/09/28 11:41:25 ENGLISH sVolume Control dSource Delete Make various other settings. Set the main zone volume setting. Remove input sources that are not used from the display. F Menu screen F Make a setting for maximum volume. [Selectable items] OFF :Do not set a maximum volume. –20dB :Set the maximum volume to –20 dB. –10dB :Set the maximum volume to –10 dB. aAmp Assign FrontB Bi-Amp Last :Use the memorized setting from the last session. ––– :Always use the muting on condition when power is turned on. in units of 1 dB. ZONE3 ZONE2/3-MONO FrontA Bi-Amp 2ch Mute Level This sets the amount of attenuation of the volume when the mute mode is set in the main zone. [Selectable items] Full :The sound is cut off entirely. Screensaver Make screensaver settings. Use the screensaver to prevent burn-in on the monitor screen. When set to “ON”, the screensaver is activated if there is no activity for about 3 minutes. [Selectable items] ON :Activate the screensaver if there is no activity for about 3 minutes. OFF :Turn the screensaver function off. Troubleshooting For details, see “Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations” (vpage 57 ~ 59). Make on-screen display related settings. Text –40dB :The sound is attenuated by 40 dB. Input source and mode display. –20dB :The sound is attenuated by 20 dB. [Selectable items] ON :Turn display on. OFF :Turn display off. Information ZONE2 fOn-Screen Display [Selectable items] –80dB ~ +18dB :Set the volume level when the power is turned on [Selectable items] 7.1ch This sets the volume set when the main zone’s power is turned on. NOTE •Input sources being used in the various zones cannot be deleted. •Input sources set to “Delete” cannot be selected using the SOURCE SELECT knob on the main unit or SOURCE SELECT button on the remote control unit. Multi-Zone The places where the surround back amplifier are used can be set freely according to the usage environment. This makes it possible to output sound to rooms other than the room (the main zone) where surround playback is performed (multi-zone playback) or play the sound with high quality using the front speakers (bi-amp connections). Power On Level Delete :Do not use this source. Remote Control Define how the amplifier for the surround back speaker channels is used. :Set the maximum volume to 0 dB. :Use this source. Playback 0dB ON Setup 2-5.Option Setup 1.Amp Assign 2.Vol.Control 3.Source Delete 4.On-Screen Display 5.Quick Select Name 6.Trigger Out 7.Remote ID Setup 8.2Way Remote 9.Display 10.Setup Lock Connections 1.Speaker Setup 2.HDMI Setup 3.Audio Setup 4.Zone Setup 5.Option Setup [Selectable items] Volume Limit 2.Manual Setup Getting Started Option Setup Master Volume Master volume display during adjustment. [Selectable items] ON :Turn display on. OFF :Turn display off. 31 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 35 2007/09/28 11:41:26 ENGLISH Getting Started Tuner Information This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation is performed. [Selectable items] Connections Always :Show display continuously. hTrigger Out jRemote ID Setup Select the conditions to turn on the trigger out with respect to the zone, input source, surround mode. For details about the trigger out function, see page 19. Set remote control ID. Match the ID setting of the remote control unit and the receiver. Select “Trigger Out 1” or “Trigger Out 2” and make the settings below respectively. Setup 30sec :Show display for 30 seconds after operation. 10sec :Show display for 10 seconds after operation. Selecting the Zone :Turn display off. Select the zone for which the trigger out is set. OFF iPod Information Playback This sets the time the on-screen display is displayed when an operation is performed. Remote Control [Selectable items] Always :Show display continuously. 30sec :Show display for 30 seconds after operation. 10sec :Show display for 10 seconds after operation. Multi-Zone OFF :Turn display off. Display Mode Select the on-screen display's display mode. Information [Selectable items] Mode1 :If there is no video signal, flickering of the on-screen display is not prevented. Troubleshooting Mode2 :Prevents flickering of the on-screen display when there is no video signal. Use this mode if the on-screen display does not appear in the Mode 1, as may happen according to the TV being used. gQuick Select Name Change the Quick Select name. Up to 16 characters can be input. [Input characters] A ~ Z a ~ z 0 ~ 9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space) Setting with Respect to the Input Source [Selectable items] 1 2 3 4 : Match the ID setting of the remote control and the receiver. When changing the remote ID, also change the AMP, iPod and TU modes of the main remote control unit at the same time (vpage 54). When the input source set to on is selected, the trigger out turns on. Setting with Respect to the Surround Mode •When the surround mode set to on is selected, the trigger out turns on. •Associated with respect to surround modes that are set to “ON”. •This can be set if the “MAIN ZONE” is selected at “Selecting the Zone”. •Associated when an input source for which “Setting with Respect to the Input Source” is set to “ON” is selected. [Selectable items] ON ––– k2Way Remote Make setting for 2-way remote control unit. [Selectable items] Used :Use 2-way remote control. Not Used :Do not use 2-way remote control. When using a 2-way remote control unit (RC-7000CI and RC-7001RCI, sold separately), set this to “Used”. :Activate trigger on this mode. :Do not activate trigger on this mode. lDisplay Adjust display brightness of the receiver. [Selectable items] Bright :Normal display brightness. Dim :Reduced display brightness. Dark :Very low display brightness. OFF :Display is off unless controls are operated. Operating from the main unit Press the DIMMER button. Bright OFF Dim Dark 32 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 36 2007/09/28 11:41:27 ENGLISH Protect settings from inadvertent change. “V.AUX”. Input Setup [Selectable items] OFF :Turn protection off. F Menu screen F 3.Input Setup CD Use this procedure to select the input source and make the settings related to playing input sources. nTUNER (AM/FM) This menu is for “TUNER”. 1.Assign 2.Input Mode 3.Rename 4.Other Setup F Menu screen F 3.Input Setup TUNER 1.Auto Preset 2.Preset Skip 3.Preset Name 4.Input Mode 5.Rename 6.Other bThe menu settings below can be made for these input sources when “iPod dock” is set to “Assign”. 3.Input Setup VCR 3-5.iPod Repeat : OFF Shuffle : OFF Remote Control 1.Assign 2.Input Mode 3.Rename 4.Other 5.iPod Multi-Zone nPHONO This menu is for “PHONO”. F Menu screen F PHONO 1.Input Mode 2.Rename 3.Other Changing the input source within Input Setup Information 3.Input Setup Playback •When “Setup Lock” is set to “ON”, the settings listed below can no longer be changed. Also, “SETUP LOCKED!” is displayed if you attempt to operate related buttons. ⋅ Menu operations ⋅ RESTORER ⋅ Night Mode ⋅ Parameter ⋅ Room EQ ⋅ Channel Level ⋅ Audio Delay •To cancel the setting, press the MENU button to re-display the “Setup Lock” screen, then change the setting to “OFF”. Connections ON :Turn protection on. Getting Started nCD, DVD, HDP, TV/CBL, SAT, VCR, DVR, V.AUX This menu is for “CD”, “DVD”, “HDP”, “TV/CBL”, “SAT”, “VCR”, “DVR”, A0Setup Lock 3.Input Setup CD Troubleshooting 1.Assign 2.Input Mode 3.Rename 4.Other The input source currently selected in the main zone is not changed even when the input source within Input Setup is changed. 33 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 37 2007/09/28 11:41:27 ENGLISH Getting Started Settings Related to Playing Input Sources Connections Auto Preset Use the auto preset function to program radio stations. [Input source] TUNER Setup [Selectable items] Start :Start the auto preset process. Input Mode Make input mode and decode mode settings for this source. The selectable input modes depend on the input source and “Assign” setting (vpage 35). Press the INPUT MODE button on the main unit or the INPUT button on the main remote control unit. AUTO Input Mode [Input source] TUNER [Selectable items] Analog :Play only signals from analog input. Playback Remote Control TV/CBL Set the preset memories that you do not want to display when tuning. SAT VCR DVR AUTO :Automatically detect input signal and perform playback. Multi-Zone HDMI :Play only signals from HDMI input. Excluding CD. Information Digital :Play only signals from digital input. Select the preset channel(s) you do not want to display. Analog :Play only signals from analog input. [Input source] TUNER EXT. IN :Play only signals from EXT. IN input. [Selectable items] Troubleshooting ON :Display this number. Skip :Skip this number. Preset Name Assign name to a preset memory. Names containing up to 8 characters can be input. Analog Set the decode mode for this source. [Selectable items] A~G Digital Decode Mode [Input source] CD DVD HDP •When a digital signal is properly input, the “ ” indicator lights on the display. If the “ ” indicator does not light, check the digital input connector assignment and the connections. •The surround mode cannot be set if the input mode is set to “EXT. IN”. TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX V.AUX Preset Skip z2 z1 z1:This can be selected for input sources for which the menu “Assign” setting is set to “HDMI” (vpage 35). Excluding CD. z2: This can be selected for input sources for which the menu “Assign” setting is set to “Digital In” (vpage 35). PHONO [Input source] CD DVD HDP HDMI EXT. IN Set the input mode for this source. EXT. IN :Play only signals from EXT. IN input. If an FM station cannot be preset automatically, select the desired station by tuning it in manually, then preset it manually. Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit [Selectable items] AUTO :Detect type of digital input signal and decode and play automatically. PCM :Decode and play only PCM input signals. DTS :Decode and play only DTS input signals. •This can be selected for input sources for which the menu “Assign” setting is set to “HDMI” or “Digital In” (vpage 35). •Only set “PCM” and “DTS” when playing the respective signals. Rename Change the display name for this source. Names containing up to 8 characters can be input. [Characters that can be input] A~Z a~z 0~9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space) A1 ~ G8 Select the preset memory number. [Input source] TUNER [Characters that can be input] A~Z a~z 0~9 ! # % & ’ ( ) * + , - . / : ; = “ ? @ [ \ ] (space) 34 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 38 2007/09/28 11:41:28 ENGLISH Assign input sources to input connectors. Digital In iPod dock Select digital input connector to assign to this source. Assign Control Dock for iPod to this source. [Input source] CD DVD HDP HDMI TV/CBL SAT DVR [Input source] CD DVD HDP V.AUX [Input source] DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT DVR :Assign COAXIAL 1 input connector. COAX2 :Assign COAXIAL 2 input connector. COAX3 :Assign COAXIAL 3 input connector. HDMI1 :Assign HDMI1 input connector. OPT1 :Assign OPTICAL 1 input connector. HDMI2 :Assign HDMI2 input connector. OPT2 :Assign OPTICAL 2 input connector. OPT3 :Assign OPTICAL 3 input connector. OPT4 :Assign OPTICAL 4 input connector. None :No digital input connector assigned. HDMI1 HDP HDMI2 TV/CBL None SAT None VCR None DVR None V.AUX None CD DVD COAX 3 COAX 1 With the default settings, the Control Dock for iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector. iPod Make settings for “iPod” playback. HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX None COAX 2 OPT 1 OPT 3 OPT 2 OPT 4 [Input source] CD DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX Multi-Zone Repeat Component In Make settings for repeat mode. Select component video input to assign to this source. [Input source] DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR Information •With HDMI, the video and audio signals are transferred simultaneously. To play the video signal assigned at “HDMI” combined with the audio signal assigned at “Digital”, select “Digital” at menu “Input Setup” – “Input Mode” (vpage 34). •When the AVR-2808 and monitor are connected with an HDMI cable, if the monitor is not compatible with HDMI audio signal playback, only the video signals are output to the monitor. •The audio signals input from the analog, digital and EXT. IN connectors are not output to the monitor. Input source Default setting None :Do not assign iPod input. [Selectable items] DVR V.AUX :Repeat all songs. One :Repeat the current song. OFF :Cancel repeat mode. Troubleshooting [Selectable items] All Remote Control DVD Assign :Assign iPod input. Playback None :No HDMI input connector assigned. DVR Setup [Selectable items] VCR [Selectable items] COAX1 V.AUX SAT V.AUX [Selectable items] VCR TV/CBL Connections Select HDMI connector to assign to this source. Input source Default setting VCR Getting Started Assign 1-RCA :Assign component video 1 input connector. 2-RCA :Assign component video 2 input connector. 3-RCA :Assign component video 3 input connector. None :No component video input connector assigned. Input source Default setting DVD HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX 1-RCA 2-RCA 3-RCA None None None None 35 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 39 2007/09/28 11:41:29 ENGLISH Getting Started Shuffle Video Convert Make settings for shuffle mode. Automatically convert video input signal to monitor output format. [Selectable items] [Input source] DVD HDP Songs :Shuffle all songs. SAT VCR DVR V.AUX Connections Albums :Shuffle songs from current album only. OFF TV/CBL [Selectable items] :Cancel shuffle mode. Setup This can be selected for input sources for which “Assign” is assigned at the “iPod dock” setting. ON :Enable conversion. OFF :Disable conversion. Standard Playback This is the standard mode for enjoying surround sound according to the program source. NOTE Playback When a non-standard video signal from a game machine or some other source is input, the video conversion function might not operate. If this happens, please set the conversion mode to “OFF”. Other Remote Control Corrects the playback level of the selected input source’s audio input. Video Select [Variable range] –12dB ~ 0dB ~ +12dB Switch video input source while listening to audio signal. Multi-Zone HDP TV/CBL SAT VCR DVR V.AUX : Select video input source to view. Information Source : The video and audio for the same input source are played. Operating from the main unit Troubleshooting Press the VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the SOURCE SELECT knob until the desired picture appears. b To cancel, press the main unit’s VIDEO SELECT button, then turn the main unit’s SOURCE SELECT knob and select “Source”. nWhen using a surround back speaker [Selectable items] DOLBY PLgx DTS NEO:6 nWhen not using a surround back speaker [Selectable items] DVD To select these surround modes pressing the STANDARD button on the main unit or press the STD button on the main remote control unit. The mode switches each time the button is pressed. Surround Playback of 2-channel Sources Source Level Make various other settings. Surround Modes For input sources for which “HDMI” and “Digital” are set at the menu “Assign” setting, the analog input level and digital input level can be set separately. [Selectable items] DOLBY PLg DOLBY PLgx or DOLBY PLg :The signals are decoded in DOLBY PLgx or DOLBY PLg for playback. Cinema :This mode is suited for movie sources. Music :This mode is suited for music sources. Game :This mode is suited for games. Pro Logic :This is the Pro Logic playback mode. This can be selected when playing with a DOLBY PLg decoder. When this mode is selected, “DOLBY PL” is displayed. NOTE •It is not possible to select HDMI input signals. •When playing HDMI video input signals, the analog video signal of another input source cannot be selected for the HDMI video output. •Input sources for which “Delete” is selected at “Source Delete” cannot be selected. DTS NEO:6 DTS NEO:6 :The signals are decoded in DTS NEO:6 for playback. Cinema :This mode is suited for movie sources. Music :This mode is suited for music sources. Select the “Cinema”,“Music”,“Game” and “Pro Logic” modes at menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” (vpage 38). 36 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 40 2007/09/28 11:41:30 ENGLISH [Selectable items] Dolby Digital Source DTS-HD HI RES DTS-HD MSTR MULTI CH IN MULTI IN+PLgx CINEMA MULTI IN+PLgx MUSIC MULTI CH IN 7.1 For details, see page 66. mode, the sound will be off balance with a single channel (left or right), so input to both channels. •Press the DSP SIMULATION button on the main unit or SIMU button on the main remote control unit to switch the surround mode. •Depending on the program source being played, it may not be possible to achieve a satisfactory surround effect. In this case, try other modes to achieve a sound field suited to your tastes. [Selectable items] DIRECT : In this mode the signals bypass the tone control circuitry for high quality sound. The sound is output to the same channels as the input signal. The display when the DIRECT mode is selected depends on the input signal. For multi-channel sources, the display depends on the surround back output’s play mode. Display Input signal Analog signal / PCM (2ch) / Dolby Digital source / DTS source / Other 2-channel digital signals DSD (2ch) PCM (multi ch) DSD (multi ch) DIRECT DSD DIRECT (z) MULTI CH DIRECT M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC M DIRECT 7.1 DSD MULTI DIRECT (z) Troubleshooting z1 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Matrix 6.1” and the AVR-2808’s “AFDM” setting is set to “ON”. z2 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS-ES Discrete 6.1”. z3 : This is displayed when the input signal is “DTS 96/24”. z:When playing sources recorded in monaural in the MONO MOVIE Direct Playback Information PCM (multi ch) / DSD (multi ch) DOLBY TrueHD DTS SURROUND DTS+PLgx CINEMA DTS+PLgx MUSIC DTS+NEO:6 DTS ES MTRX6.1 (z1) DTS ES DSCRT6.1 (z2) DTS 96/24 (z3) The mode switches between DIRECT and STEREO each time the DIRECT/STEREO button on the main unit or the D/ST button on the main remote control unit is pressed. Multi-Zone DVDAudio, SACD DOLBY DIGITAL + :This mode is for enjoying stereo sound from all speakers. :This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of WIDE SCREEN viewing a movie on a large screen. SUPER STADIUM :This mode is suited for viewing sports programs. :This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a ROCK ARENA live concert in an arena. :This mode is for enjoying the atmosphere of a JAZZ CLUB live concert in a jazz club. CLASSIC CONCERT :This mode is for appreciating classical concert programs. z :This mode is for playing monaural movie MONO MOVIE sources with surround sound. :This mode is suited for achieving surround VIDEO GAME sound with video games. :This mode lets you add a sense of expansion MATRIX to stereo music sources. :This mode is for enjoying surround effects VIRTUAL using only the front speakers or headphones. Remote Control DTS Surround Source Display DOLBY DIGITAL DOLBY DIGITAL EX DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx CINEMA DOLBY DIGITAL+PLgx MUSIC 7CH STEREO STEREO : This is the mode for playing in stereo. The tone can be adjusted. Sound is output from the front left and right speakers and subwoofer. Playback DOLBY DIGITAL (other than 2ch) / DOLBY DIGITAL EX DOLBY DIGITAL Plus DOLBY TrueHD DTS (5.1ch) / DTS-ES Discrete 6.1 / DTS-ES Matrix 6.1 / DTS 96/24 DTS-HD High Resolution Audio DTS-HD Master Audio [Selectable items] [Selectable items] Setup Input signal The desired mode according to the program source and viewing situation can be selected from among 10 DENON original surround modes. The surround parameters can be adjusted (vpage 64, 65) to achieve an even more realistic, powerful sound field. Stereo Playback Connections STANDARD : his mode is for decoding the input signals according to their format T and playing surround sound. The display when the STANDARD mode is selected depends on the input signal and surround back output playback mode. DSP Simulation Playback Getting Started Playing Multi-channel Sources (Dolby Digital, DTS, etc.) z :When DSD signals are converted to PCM signals as set by the audio parameters and speaker settings, “DIRECT” or “MULTI CH DIRECT” is displayed. For details, see page 67. 37 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 41 2007/09/28 11:41:31 ENGLISH Getting Started Playback in the PURE DIRECT Mode This is the mode that recreates the original sound most faithfully, providing extremely high quality sound. Connections Press the PURE DIRECT button on the main unit or the PURE button on the main remote control unit. Setup Playback •When in the PURE DIRECT mode, the menu screen is not displayed and the display on the main unit is turned off. •If the HDMI input connector is selected, video outputs are output in the PURE DIRECT mode. •The channel level and surround parameters in the PURE DIRECT mode are the same as in the DIRECT mode. The MUSIC mode is also effective for movie sources including a lot of stereo music. Parameter CINEMA EQ Parameters can be called out directly by pressing the PARA button on the main remote control unit. Soften the treble understanding. range of movie soundtracks for better [Selectable items] F Menu screen F 4.Parameter 1.Surround Parameter 2.Tone Control 3.Room EQ 4.RESTORER 5.Night Mode 6.Audio Delay ON :CINEMA EQ is used. OFF :CINEMA EQ is not used. D.COMP Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds). Remote Control [Selectable items] OFF :Turn dynamic range compression off. Multi-Zone aSurround Parameter LOW :Low setting. Adjust surround sound parameters. The adjustable parameters differ for the different surround modes (vpage 64, 65). MID :Middle setting. MODE Information Select the mode according to the playback source. nIn the PLgx mode Troubleshooting PLgx MUSIC Compress dynamic range (difference between loud and soft sounds). PLgx GAME [Selectable items] nIn the PLg mode AUTO :Automatic dynamic range compression on/off control [Selectable items] PLg CINEMA PLg MUSIC PLg GAME according to source. DOLBY PL nIn the DTS NEO:6 mode [Selectable items] CINEMA When playing DTS sources, this is only displayed for compatible software. DRC [Selectable items] PLgx CINEMA HIGH :High setting. MUSIC LOW :Low setting. MID :Middle setting. HIGH :High setting. OFF :Dynamic range compression always off. CINEMA : Surround sound mode optimized for movie sources. MUSIC : Surround sound mode optimized for music sources. GAME PL This can be set in the Dolby TrueHD mode. : Surround sound mode optimized for games. : Dolby Pro Logic playback mode. 38 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 42 2007/09/28 11:41:31 ENGLISH EFFECT Adjust the low-frequency effects level (LFE). Switch effect signal for multi-surround speakers on and off. When “EFFECT” is set to “ON”, a surround effect with a strong sense of expansion is achieved. [Variable range] –10dB ~ 0dB [Selectable items] OFF LEVEL Select playback mode for surround back channels. Adjust effect signal level. [Selectable items] ~ 10 ~ 15 1.0 ROOM SIZE PANORAMA Determine size of acoustic environment. Assign front L/R signal also to surround channels, for wider sound. If the surround effect seems weak, set “PANORAMA” to “ON”. [Selectable items] OFF ON medium ~ 3 ~ med. l large 6 :Simulate acoustics of a large room. NOTE CENTER WIDTH ~ 3 ~ 7 DELAY TIME Adjust delay time to control sound stage size. [Variable range] 0 ms ~ 30 ms ~ 300 ms AFDM (Auto Flag Detect Mode) Auto-select surround mode by source. This function only works for software containing a special identification signal. If the software being played is recorded in Dolby Digital EX or DTS-ES, it is played in 6.1-channels. If not, it is played in 5.1-channels. [Selectable items] ON :The surround channel signals undergo digital matrix processing and are output from the surround back channels. z1 :Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Cinema mode, PLIIx CINEMA surround back signal played. z2 :Decoded in Dolby Pro Logic IIx Music mode, PLIIx MUSIC surround back signal played. z3 :DTS signal played with digital matrix processing. ES MTRX z4 :Signal included in DTS-ES Discrete 6.1-channel ES DSCRT sources played. DSCRT ON :Mode for discrete playback of surround back signals included in 7.1-channel digital discrete audio signals (DVD, etc.). z1:This can be selected when “Surround Back Speaker” is set to “2spkrs” at the menu “Manual Setup” – “Speaker Setup” – “Speaker Configuration” setting (vpage 26). z2:This can be selected when “Surround Back Speaker” is set to “2spkrs” or “1spkr” at the menu “Manual Setup” – “Speaker Setup” –“Speaker Configuration” setting. z3:This can be selected when playing DTS sources. z4:This can be selected when playing DTS sources including a discrete 6.1-channel signal identification signal. Troubleshooting Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider sound. “ROOM SIZE” does not indicate the size of the room in which sources are played. MTRX ON Information Shift sound image center to front or rear, to adjust playback balance. [Variable range] 0 :Simulate acoustics of a small room. med. s DIMENSION [Variable range] 0 small :The same signals as those of the surround channels are output from the surround back channels. Multi-Zone [Selectable items] NON MTRX Remote Control ~ 0.3 :No signal is played from the surround back channels. Playback ~ [Variable range] 0.0 Set to a lower level if the positioning and sense of phase of the surround signals seems unnatural. OFF Setup [Variable range] 1 CENTER IMAGE Assign center channel signal to front left and right channels for wider sound. SB CH OUT (for Multi-channel sources) Connections For proper playback of the different program sources, we recommend setting to the values below. •Dolby Digital sources: “0 dB” •DTS movie sources: “0 dB” •DTS music sources: “–10 dB” ON Some Dolby Digital EX sources do not include EX flags. If the playback mode does not switch automatically even when “AFDM” is set to “ON”, set “SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON” or “PLIIx CINEMA”. Getting Started LFE OFF Example : Playing Dolby Digital software (with EX flag) •When “AFDM” is set to “ON”, the surround mode is automatically set to the DOLBY D + PLgx C mode. •To play in the DOLBY DIGITAL EX mode, set “AFDM” to “OFF” and “SB CH OUT” to “MTRX ON”. 39 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 43 2007/09/28 11:41:33 ENGLISH Getting Started SB CH OUT (for 2-channel sources) Determine whether to use surround back speakers. sTone Control dRoom EQ Adjust the tonal quality of the sound. Select room equalizer for current environment. [Selectable items] Connections ON :The surround back channel signal is played. Tone Defeat OFF :The surround back channel signal is not played. Turn tone adjustments off. [Selectable items] Setup This operation can be performed directly pressing the SURROUND BACK button on the main unit. ON :Playback without tone control. OFF :Allow tone control (treble, bass). Playback SW ATT (Subwoofer Attenuate) Attenuate subwoofer level when using EXT. IN mode. [Selectable items] Bass Remote Control :The input from the subwoofer channel is attenuated. Adjust low frequency range (bass). OFF :The input from the subwoofer channel is not attenuated. Usually use in this mode. [Variable range] –6dB ~ +6dB Treble Multi-Zone Adjust high frequency range (treble). [Variable range] –6dB ~ +6dB Subwoofer Information Turn subwoofer output on and off. Audyssey “Bass” and “Treble” can be set when “Tone Defeat” is set to “OFF”. :Optimize frequency response of all speakers. Audyssey Byp. L/R :Optimize frequency response of speakers except front L and R speakers. Audyssey Flat :Optimize frequency response of all speakers to flat response. Manual :Apply frequency response set with “Manual EQ” (vpage 29). The tone cannot be adjusted when in the DIRECT mode. ON Set this to “ON” if the subwoofer channel level seems too high when playing Super Audio CD. [Selectable items] OFF :Turn equalizer off. Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit Press the ROOM EQ button on the main unit or the EQ button on the main remote control. Audyssey OFF Manual When “Audyssey” is selected, “ Audyssey Byp. L/R Audyssey Flat ” lights. When “Audyssey Byp. L/R” or “Audyssey Flat” is selected, or when the auto setup measuring results have changed, “ ” lights. [Selectable items] Troubleshooting ON :The subwoofer is used. OFF :The subwoofer is not used. Default Resets the settings to the default values. •“Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and “Audyssey Flat” can be selected after the auto setup procedure has been performed. •If the settings of the speakers for which “None” has been determined at “Auto Setup” are changed, “Audyssey”, “Audyssey Byp. L/R” and “Audyssey Flat” cannot be selected and measurements have to be taken again to include the newly-added speakers. •When using headphones, “Room EQ” is always set to “OFF”. 40 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 44 2007/09/28 11:41:33 ENGLISH gNight Mode This function restores compressed audio signals to how they were before compression and corrects the sense of volume of the bass and treble to obtain richer playback sound. Optimized setting for late-night listening. :Turn night mode off. LOW :Low setting. : Apply suitable bass and treble boost for all compressed sources. Mode3 (RESTORER HQ): OFF Surround Mode: STEREO Input Mode :ANALOG 1/4 hAudio Delay aMain Zone Compensate for mismatched timing between video and audio. Shows information about settings for main zone. The items displayed differ according to the input source. Delay audio. This sets the delay time for audio signals. [Variable range] 0 ms ~ 200 ms If you wish to adjust the “Audio Delay” while playing HDMI or component video signals, press u to set “OSD” to “OFF”. This way the audio delay can be adjusted while watching the picture. (Press u again to switch to the on-screen display.) Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit bWhen set using the procedure below, the on-screen display is not displayed. Adjust while watching the display. q Press the AUDIO DELAY button on the main unit or the A. DL button on the main remote control unit. w Use the o p button to set. [Items to be checked] Select Source Name Surround Mode Input Mode Rec Select Video Select Night Mode Source Level Room EQ RESTORER etc. Troubleshooting About the RESTORER function •Such compressed audio formats as MP3, WMA (Windows Media Audio) and MPEG-4 AAC reduce the amount of data by eliminating signal components that are hard for the human ear to hear. The RESTORER function generates the signals eliminated upon compression, restoring the sound to conditions near those of the original sound before compression. It also corrects the sense of volume of the bass to obtain richer sound with compressed audio signals. •This is displayed on the menu and can be set when the analog signals (including AM/FM signals) or PCM signals (fs = 44.1/48 kHz) are input. Select Source: PHONO Name :Record Information Mode 2 (RESTORER 96) 5-1.Status Multi-Zone During playback, press the RESTORER button on the main unit or the RSTR button on the main remote control unit. When set to something other than “OFF”, “ ” is displayed. MID HIGH The default setting for “iPod” is “Mode3”. All others are set to “OFF”. Operating from the main unit or main remote control unit LOW 1.Status 2.Audio Input Signal 3.HDMI Information 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Quick Select 6.Preset Station Remote Control Optimized mode for compressed sources with normal highs. Press the NGT button. The “ ” indicator lights when “LOW”, “MID” or “HIGH” is selected. 5.Information Playback Mode2 (RESTORER 96): F Menu screen F Operating from the main remote control unit Setup Optimized mode for compressed sources with very weak highs. Mode 1 (RESTORER 64) Mode 3 (RESTORER HQ) Shows information about current settings. HIGH :High setting. Mode1 (RESTORER 64): OFF Status MID :Middle setting. Do not use RESTORER. Connections OFF Information [Selectable items] OFF [Selectable items] Getting Started fRESTORER sZONE2 / ZONE3 Shows information about settings for multi-zone. [Items to be checked] Power Select Source Volume Level •This cannot be adjusted when playing in the EXT. IN, DIRECT or STEREO mode (with “Front Speaker” set to “Large”, “Tone Defeat” to “ON” and “Room EQ” to “OFF”.) •The adjustment range is 0 to 100 ms when the Auto Lipsync Correction function is activated. 41 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 45 2007/09/28 11:41:34 ENGLISH Getting Started Audio Input Signal HDMI Information Quick Select Shows information about audio input signals. Shows information about HDMI input signal and monitor. Shows information about quick select settings. F Menu screen F F Menu screen F F Menu screen F 5.Information 5.Information Connections 1.Status 2.Audio Input Signal 3.HDMI Information 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Quick Select 6.Preset Station 5-2.Audio Input Signal Surround Mode: DOLBY DIGITAL EX Setup SIGNAL:Dolby Digital fs :48kHz Format:3/2/.1 Offset:-4dB Playback [Items to be checked] Surround Mode : The currently set surround mode is displayed. Remote Control SIGNAL fs Format Multi-Zone Offset Flag : The input signal type is displayed. Information : The input signal’s sampling frequency is displayed. : The number of channels in the input signal (front, surround, LFE) is displayed. : The dialogue normalization correction value is displayed. : “MATRIX” is displayed if the input signal has undergone matrix processing, “DISCRETE” if the input signal has undergone discrete processing. 5.Information 1.Status 2.Audio Input Signal 3.HDMI Information 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Quick Select 6.Preset Station 5-3.HDMI Signal Info. Resolution 480p Color Space RGB 4:4:4 5-5.Quick Select 1.Quick Select 1 2.Quick Select 2 3.Quick Select 3 Pixel Depth 8bits 1/2 [Items to be checked] aHDMI Signal Information The HDMI input signal information is displayed. Name Input Source Analog/PCM 2CH Input Mode Multi ch Volume Level Digital 2CH Digital 5.1CH [Items to be checked] Resolution Color Space Pixel Depth For instructions on storing settings at Quick Select 1 to 3, see page 50. sHDMI Monitor Information The HDMI monitor information is displayed. Interface Preset Station Shows information about preset stations. [Items to be checked] F Menu screen F Support Resolution 5.Information Dialogue normalization function Troubleshooting This is automatically activated when playing Dolby Digital sources. This function automatically corrects the standard signal level for individual program sources. The correction value can be checked using the STATUS button on the main unit. 1.Status 2.Audio Input Signal 3.HDMI Information 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Quick Select 6.Preset Station Auto Surround Mode Shows information about auto surround mode settings. The surround mode for which the last memory function was used for the different input signal types is displayed. 1.Status 2.Audio Input Signal 3.HDMI Information 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Quick Select 6.Preset Station 5-6.Preset Station A1FM 87.50MHz A2FM 89.10MHz A3FM 98.10MHz A4FM108.00MHz A5FM 90.10MHz A6FM 90.10MHz A7FM 90.10MHz A8FM 90.10MHz F Menu screen F 5.Information The figure is the correction value when the standard level is corrected. 1.Status 2.Audio Input Signal 3.HDMI Information 4.Auto Surround Mode 5.Quick Select 6.Preset Station 5-4.Auto Surround Mode [Analog][PCM] 2CH:STEREO [Multi ch] :MULTI CH IN [Digital] 2CH:DOLBY PLIIx Cinema 5.1CH:DOLBY/DTS SURROUND [Input source] TUNER [Items to be checked] A1 ~ G8 Operating from the main unit When the STATUS button on the main unit is pressed, the set’s status can be checked on the display. [Items to be checked] Analog/PCM 2CH Multi ch Digital 2CH Digital 5.1CH 42 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 46 2007/09/28 11:41:36 ENGLISH SOURCE SELECT <SOURCE> MASTER VOLUME SPEAKER Playback Turning the Power On Press <POWER>. 2 Press <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER ON]. The power indicator flashes green and the power turns on. To operate the AVR-2808 using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”). AMP] Operations During Playback Adjusting the Master Volume Either turn <MASTER VOLUME> or press [MASTER VOLUME]. Turning Off the Sound Temporarily (Muting) Press [MUTE]. [POWER ON] MASTER VOLUME SOURCE SELECT NOTE Power continues to be supplied to some of the circuitry even when the power is in the standby mode. When leaving home for long periods of time or when traveling, either press <POWER> to turn off the power, or unplug the power cord from the power outlet. Listening with Headphones Plug the headphones into <PHONES>. The sound from the speakers and pre-out connectors is automatically cut. NOTE Be careful not to set the volume too high when using headphones. Selecting the Input Source Operation on the Main Unit Turn <SOURCE SELECT>. Troubleshooting [MUTE] [POWER OFF] To cancel, press [MUTE] again. Muting can also be canceled by adjusting the master volume. Information SPEAKER qPress <ON/STANDBY> or [POWER OFF]. The power is set to the standby mode. wPress <POWER>. The power indicator turns off, and so does the power. Multi-Zone Turning the Power Off Remote Control [ <PHONES> To operate the AVR-2808 using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the AMP mode (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”). Playback <POWER> <ON/STANDBY> The power indicator lights red and the power is set to the standby mode. The desired input source can be selected directly. Setup 1 Press [SOURCE SELECT]. Connections Preparations Getting Started Operation on the Main Remote Control Unit Switching the Front Speakers Press SPEAKER. Front A Front B Front A+B About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit If “Rec Select” or “Video Select” is selected for the input source, press <SOURCE> before turning <SOURCE SELECT>. 43 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 47 2007/09/28 11:41:37 ENGLISH Getting Started Playing Video and Audio Equipment SOURCE SELECT Basic Operation 1 Prepare the equipment. Connections Setup qLoad the DVD, CD or other software in the player. (vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.) wTo play a video device, switch the monitor input. (vSee the monitor’s operating instructions.) Playback 2 To operate using the main remote control unit, set the <TUNING PRESET> remote control unit to the AMP mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) 3 4 Remote Control Use SOURCE SELECT to select the input source. [ TU] ( Multi-Zone [BAND] [MODE] [df] Listening to FM/AM Broadcasts [MEMO] Information Basic Operation [SEARCH] Either turn Troubleshooting [CHANNEL] [TUNER] (AMP mode), [SHIFT] 1 2 [1 ~ 8], SOURCE SELECT (AMP mode) 1 2 3 Press [MEMO]. Press [A ~ G] to select the block in which the station is to be preset, then press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select the preset number. bThe memory block can also be selected by pressing [SHIFT]. <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER] (AMP mode) to select “TUNER”. 4 Press [MEMO] again to complete the setting. To operate using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) 3 4 Press [BAND] to select “FM” or “AM”. Tune in the desired broadcast station. About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit Your favorite broadcast stations can be preset so that you can tune them in easily. Up to 56 stations can be preset. (vSee the operating instructions of the respective devices.) [A ~ G] Presetting Radio Stations (Preset Memory) Tune in the broadcast station you want to preset. Start playback. mode) •It is also possible to switch to “FM” or “AM” in step 1 by pressing [TUNER]. •If the desired station cannot be tuned in with auto tuning, tune it in manually. •When tuning in stations manually, press and hold [df] to change frequencies continuously. •The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” (vpage 31, 32). •To preset other stations, repeat steps 1 to 4. •Stations can be preset automatically at menu “Input Setup” – “Auto Preset” (vpage 34). NOTE Preset stations are erased by overwriting them. qTo tune in automatically (Auto Tuning) Press [MODE] to light the “AUTO” indicator on the display, then use [df] to select the station you want to hear. wTo tune in manually (Manual Tuning) Press [MODE] to turn off the display’s “AUTO” indicator, then use [df] to select the station you want to hear. 44 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 48 2007/09/28 11:41:38 ENGLISH Operation on the Main Unit Operation on the Main Remote Control Unit channel. Auto tuner presets PTY identifies the type of RDS program. The program types and their displays are as follows: 522 / 603 / 999 / 1404 / 1611 kHz, 90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 MHz C1 ~ C8 90.1 MHz D1 ~ D8 90.1 MHz E1 ~ E8 90.1 MHz EASY M F1 ~ F8 90.1 MHz G1 ~ G8 90.1 MHz LIGHT M CLASSICS OTHER M Weather Finance Children’s CHILDREN programmes SOCIAL Social Affairs RELIGION Religion PHONE IN Phone In TRAVEL Travel LEISURE Leisure JAZZ Jazz Music COUNTRY Country Music NATION M National Music OLDIES Oldies Music FOLK M Folk Music DOCUMENT Documentary WEATHER FINANCE remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) 3 4 Press [SEARCH] to select “RDS”. Press [CHANNEL]. The search for RDS stations begins automatically. bIf no RDS stations are found with the above operation, all the reception bands are searched. bWhen a broadcast station is found, that station’s name appears on the display. 5 To continue searching, repeat steps 2 to 3. bIf no RDS station is found when all the frequencies have been searched, “NO RDS” is displayed. Information B1 ~ B8 <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER] (AMP mode) to select “TUNER”. Multi-Zone A1 ~ A8 87.5 / 89.1 / 98.1 / 108.0 / 90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 / 90.1 MHz News Current Affairs Information Sports Education Drama Culture Science Varied Pop Music Rock Music Easy Listening Music Light Classical Serious Classical Other Music Either turn To operate using the main remote control unit, set the Program Type (PTY) NEWS AFFAIRS INFO SPORT EDUCATE DRAMA CULTURE SCIENCE VARIED POP M ROCK M 1 2 Remote Control nDefault settings Use this function to automatically tune to FM stations that provide the RDS service. Playback Press [CHANNEL] or [1 ~ 8] to select the desired preset RDS (works only on the FM band) is a broadcasting service which allows a station to send additional information along with the regular radio program signal. The following three types of RDS information can be received with this unit: Setup 1 2 Press [A ~ G] to select the memory block. RDS Search Connections Press <TUNING PRESET>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT> to select the preset radio station. RDS (Radio Data System) Getting Started Listening to Preset Stations Troubleshooting Traffic Program (TP) TP identifies programs that carry traffic announcements. This allows you to easily find out the latest traffic conditions in your area before leaving home. Radio Text (RT) RT allows RDS stations to send text messages that appear on the display. NOTE The operations described below using [SEARCH] will not function in areas in which there are no RDS broadcasts. 45 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 49 2007/09/28 11:41:38 ENGLISH Getting Started <SOURCE SELECT> uiop PTY Search TP Search Use this function to find RDS stations broadcasting a designated program type (PTY). For a description of each program type, refer to “Program Type (PTY)”. Use this function to find RDS stations broadcasting traffic programs (TP stations). Connections 1 2 Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER] (AMP mode) to select “TUNER”. Setup Playback <ON/STANDBY> Remote Control [ TU] ( mode) Multi-Zone Information ENTER uiop [SEARCH] Troubleshooting [CHANNEL] [TUNER] ENTER 3 4 5 remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) Press [SEARCH] to select “PTY”. Watching the display, press ui to call out the desired [ iPod] [8], [9], [6], [7], [1], [2] ENTER uiop [SEARCH] [CHANNEL +/–] Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER] (AMP mode) to select “TUNER”. To operate using the main remote control unit, set the To operate using the main remote control unit, set the 1 2 program type. Press [CHANNEL]. PTY search begins automatically. bIf there is no station broadcasting the designated program type with the above operation, all the reception bands are searched. bThe station name is displayed on the display after searching stops. remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) 3 4 Press [SEARCH] to select “TP”. Press [CHANNEL]. TP search begins automatically. bIf no TP station is found with the above operation, all the reception bands are searched. bThe station name is displayed on the display after searching stops. 5 To continue searching, repeat steps 2 to 3. bIf no other TP station is found when all the frequencies have been searched, “NO PROGRAMME” is displayed. 6 To continue searching, repeat steps 2 to 4. bIf no station broadcasting the designated program type is found when all the frequencies have been searched, “NO PROGRAMME” is displayed. [iPod] (AMP mode) (AMP mode) About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit 46 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 50 2007/09/28 11:41:39 ENGLISH “RT” appears on the display when radio text data is received. Either turn To operate using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the TUNER ( ) mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) Press [SEARCH] to select “RT”. b The iPod may only be used to copy or play contents that are not copyrighted or contents for which copying or playback is legally permitted for your private use as an individual. Be sure to comply with applicable copyright legislation. Basic Operation Make the necessary preparations. qSet the iPod in the DENON Control Dock for iPod. (vSee the Control Dock for iPod’s operating instructions.) w Assign the Control Dock for iPod’s input. MENU : ”Input Setup” – “Assign” – ”iPod dock” mode) to select the input source assigned in step 1-w above. ui to select the menu, then press ENTER or p to select the music file to be played. Use Press ENTER or p. Playback starts. Information 2 Either turn <SOURCE SELECT> or press [iPod] (AMP 1 2 Multi-Zone (vpage 35) Listening to Music Stopping playback temporarily During playback, press ENTER or [1]. Press again to resume playback. Fast-forwarding or fast-reversing (iPod screen) b If the screens above are not displayed, the iPod may not be properly connected. Try connecting again. 3 To operate using the main remote control unit, set the remote control unit to the iPod mode. (vpage 51 “Remote Control Unit Operations”) To cue to the beginning of a track During playback, either press u (to cue to the previous track) or i (to cue to the next track), or press [8] or [9]. Troubleshooting During playback, either press and hold u (to fast-reverse) or i (to fastforward), or press [6] or [7]. OK to disconnect. Remote Control 1 NOTE • Depending on the type of iPod and the software version, some functions may not operate. • DENON will accept no responsibility whatsoever for any loss of iPod data. Playback b While receiving an RDS broadcast station, the text data broadcast from the station is displayed. b To turn the display off, press op. b If no text data is being broadcast, “NO TEXT DATA” is displayed. iPod is a trademark of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. Setup 3 <SOURCE SELECT> or press [TUNER] (AMP mode) to select “TUNER”. • With the default settings, the iPod can be used connected to the VCR (iPod) connector. • Use the RESTORER mode to expand the low and high frequency components of compressed audio files and achieve a richer sound. The default setting is “Mode3”. • Press <ON/STANDBY> and set the AVR-2808’s power to the standby mode before disconnecting the iPod. Also switch the input source to one to which the menu “iPod dock” is not assigned before disconnecting the iPod. Connections 1 2 The music on an iPod can be played by using the Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R, sold separately). The operation can also be performed using the buttons on the main unit or remote control unit while watching the menus. Getting Started iPod® Playback RT (Radio Text) To stop During playback, either press and hold ENTER or press [2]. Playing repeatedly Press [CHANNEL –]. [Selectable items] All One OFF MENU : ”Input Setup” – ”iPod” – “Repeat” (vpage 35) 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 51 2007/09/28 11:41:41 ENGLISH Getting Started Shuffling playback Press [CHANNEL +]. [Selectable items] Albums Songs Surround mode <SOURCE SELECT> OFF uiop <STATUS> MENU : ”Input Setup” – ”iPod” – “Shuffle” (vpage 36) Other Operations and Functions Connections Searching up or down pages Press [SEARCH], then press o (down) or p (up). To cancel, press ui or [SEARCH]. Other Operations To switch between the Browse and Remote modes Setup Either press and hold [SEARCH]. Playing Super Audio CD Playback Remote Control • The title name, artist name and album name can be checked by pressing <STATUS> during playback. • On the AVR-2808, folder and file names can be displayed as titles. Any characters that cannot be displayed are replaced with “ . (period)”. • The time for which the menus are displayed can be set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “On-Screen Display” – “iPod Information” (vpage 32). INPUT MODE <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> CH SELECT [ Multi-Zone Information Photo and video data on the iPod can be viewed on the monitor. Only for iPod equipped with slideshow or video functions. (When using an ASD-1R) Troubleshooting 1 2 3 Press and hold [SEARCH] to set the Remote mode. “Remote iPod” is displayed on the AVR-2808’s display. Watching the iPod’s screen, use Assign the HDMI input connector at the “HDMI” setting (vpage 35). <SOURCE SELECT> or press [SOURCE to select the input source assigned in step 1. Either turn The “ AMP] Viewing Still Pictures or Videos on the iPod 1 2 SELECT] 3 ” indicator lights on the display. Use INPUT MODE to select “AUTO” (vpage 34). Surround mode INPUT MODE 4 5 Select the input mode according to the program source to be played. Select the surround mode (vpage 36 ~ 38). We recommend playing in the DIRECT mode. Start playing the Super Audio CD. CH SELECT uiop The “ ” indicator lights on the display. For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s operating instructions. ui to select “Photos” or “Videos”. Press ENTER until the image you want to view is displayed. [SOURCE SELECT] “TV Out” at the iPod’s “Slideshow Settings” or “Video Settings” must be set to “On” in order to display the iPod’s photo data or videos on the monitor. For details, see the iPod’s operating instructions. • When playing DSD signals in the DIRECT or PURE DIRECT mode, the DSD signals are converted as such into analog signals. When playing in other surround modes, the DSD signals are first converted into PCM format, then into analog signals. • “DSD DIRECT” is shown on the display when playing DSD 2-channel signals in the DIRECT mode. “DSD MULTI DIRECT” is shown on the display when playing DSD multi--channel signals in the DIRECT mode. About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 52 2007/09/28 11:41:42 ENGLISH You can listen to one program source while recording a different program source. Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>. ZONE2 SOURCE ZONE2 TUNER RECOUT V. AUX ······ ···· RECOUT TUNER ZONE2 V. AUX RECOUT SOURCE The “ Turn ” indicator lights. <SOURCE SELECT> to choose the input source Press ui or CH SELECT to select “Fader”. Convenient Functions Use o p to adjust the volume of the speakers. Channel Level You can adjust the channel level either according to the playback sources or to suit your taste, as described below. 1 Press CH SELECT. Channel Volume FL C FR SW to be recorded. Press CH SELECT. 0.0dB 0.0dB 0.0dB 0.0dB SR SBR SBL SL 0.0dB 0.0dB 0.0dB 0.0dB (o: front, p: rear) •The fader function does not affect the subwoofer. •The fader can be adjusted until the volume of the speaker adjusted to the lowest value is –12 dB. Play the program source. For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s operating instructions. Use ui or CH SELECT to select the speaker. The speaker that can be set switches each time one of the buttons is pressed. 3 Use o p to adjust the volume. Troubleshooting •To cancel, press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT>, then turn <SOURCE SELECT> until “ZONE2 SOURCE” is displayed. • Make a test recording before starting the actual recording. • Signals are only output to the analog REC OUT connectors when the digital signals input to the digital input connectors (OPTICAL/ COAXIAL) are PCM (2-channel) signals. •Digital audio signals input to the HDMI connectors are not output to the REC OUT connectors, so connect using the OPTICAL or COAXIAL connectors. •Sources selected with the REC OUT mode are output from ZONE2 as well. •In the REC OUT mode, the remote control unit’s ZONE2 mode buttons cannot be operated. 2 Information Start recording. Fader FRONT : REAR Multi-Zone 5 For operating instructions, refer to the respective equipment’s operating instructions. To record FM or AM broadcasts, select the broadcast (vpage 44). Remote Control 3 4 is displayed. 1 2 3 Playback Turn <SOURCE SELECT> until “RECOUT SOURCE” This function lets you adjust (fade) the sound from all the front or rear speakers at once. Setup 2 “ZONE2 SOURCE” is shown on the display. Fader Function Connections 1 NOTE •Recordings you make are for your personal enjoyment and should not be used for other purposes without permission of the copyright holder. •Input sources for which “Delete” is selected at “Source Delete”cannot be selected. Getting Started Recording on an External Device (REC OUT mode) b“OFF” can be set by pressing o when the subwoofer’s volume is set to –12 dB. 49 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 53 2007/09/28 11:41:43 ENGLISH Getting Started <STANDARD> <DSP SIMULATION> Quick Select Function Last Function Memory With this function, the currently playing input source, input mode, surround mode, room EQ settings and volume can be stored in the memory. This stores the settings as they were directly before the standby mode was set. When the power is turned back on, the settings are restored to as they were directly before the standby mode was set. 1 Connections Set the input source, input mode, surround mode, 2 room EQ settings and volume to the conditions you want to store. Setup Press and hold the desired QUICK SELECT. Playback <POWER> Keep pressing the button until the quick select indicator lights. QUICK SELECT Remote Control Input Source DVD TV/CBL VCR Volume –40 dB –40 dB –40 dB Multi-Zone •To call out the settings, press QUICK SELECT at which the desired settings were stored. • The Quick Select name can be changed (vpage 32). NOTE Information Input sources stored with the quick select function cannot be selected if they have been deleted at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Source Delete” (vpage 31). In this case, store them again. Troubleshooting Personal Memory Plus Function This function sets the settings (input mode, surround mode, etc.) last selected for the individual input sources. When you switch to an input source, the settings are automatically set to the ones that were set the last time that input source was used. About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit The various settings are backed up for about 1 week, even if the power is turned off or the power cord is disconnected. [Quick Select Defaults] Quick Select 1 Quick Select 2 Quick Select 3 QUICK SELECT Backup Memory Resetting the Microprocessor Perform this procedure if the display is abnormal or if operations cannot be performed. When the microprocessor is reset, all the settings are reset to their default values. <POWER> 1 <POWER> 2 <STANDARD> <DSP SIMULATION> 3 Turn off the power using Press and . while simultaneously pressing . Once the display starts flashing at intervals of about 1 second, release the two buttons. If in step 3 the display does not flash at intervals of about 1 second, start over from step 1. The surround parameters, tone control, room EQ settings and the volumes of the different speakers are stored for the individual surround modes. 50 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 54 2007/09/28 11:41:44 ENGLISH Remote Control Unit Operations 1 Press :TUNER (FM/AM) : iPod :NET/USB / DIGITAL TUNER : DVD player (Recorder) / CD player (Recorder) : VCR / TAPE :Satellite Receiver / Cable TV : TV Press Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. GAMP modeH GZONE2 modeH brand of the component to be preset. The numbers are shown in the Preset Code Table (vEnd of this manual). When the code is registered, the signal transmission indicator flashes twice. When the preset code is transmitted, the mode indicator for the component to which that code belongs flashes. GZONE3 modeH bThe input mode is canceled if no button is operated for 10 seconds. GSYSTEM CALL modeH 1 Press GZONE4 modeH [MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be operated. Troubleshooting [HOME] The mode indicator of the device to be operated flashes. 2 [NUMBER] Operate the component. [RC SETUP] Information Operating Preset Components Multi-Zone Some brands have more than one preset code. If the component does not operate, try inputting a different code. Remote Control The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [NUMBER] and input the 5-digit number of the bThe mode switches each time [AMP] is pressed. [MODE SELECTOR] [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to preset. Playback bThe TUNER ( ), NET/DTU ( and ) mode is not used on the AVR-2808, so use the learn function to store the signals (vpage 54). 1 2 3 Setup AMP] The indicator for the component to be operated flashes. The included main remote control unit can be preset to operate devices of various brands. Connections [ Signal transmission indicator operated. :AMP / ZONE2 / ZONE3 / ZONE4 / SYSTEM CALL Main Remote Control Unit •On the main remote control unit, the display switches according to the device being operated and the mode. •In modes other than iPod, the mode switches between“ ” and “ ” each time the [MODE SELECTOR] is pressed. •In the AMP, TUNER and iPod modes, when the remote ID is set, the AVR-2808 can be used independently even in an environment containing multiple DENON amplifiers. [MODE SELECTOR] for the component to be Presetting Getting Started Operating DENON Audio Components bFor details, refer to the component’s operating instructions. 2 Operate the component. Depending on the model and year of manufacture of your equipment, some buttons may not operate. bFor details, refer to the component’s operating instructions. NOTE The device mode (“ setting is being made. ” or “ ”) cannot be changed while the [HOME] is used to return to the AMP mode (AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3, ZONE4 or SYSTEM CALL) when in any mode other than AMP. 51 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 55 2007/09/28 11:41:46 ENGLISH Getting Started Functions of Buttons by Component EL Display EL Display Connections [MODE SELECTOR] Setup Playback [MENU] Remote Control [SETUP/ SEARCH] Multi-Zone [CH + / SHUFFLE], [CH – / REPEAT] Buttons MODE SELECTOR [1], [8 9], [6 7], [3], [2], [SOURCE ON], [SOURCE OFF] [ENTER] [uiop] [RETURN] DVD VCR iPod Device Mode Device operated 1 8 9 6 7 DVD (Default setting) Playback Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) CD Recorder VCR TAPE iPod Playback Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) CD (Default setting) Playback Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) Playback Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) Playback Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) Playback Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) Playback/Pause Auto search (cue) Manual search (fast-reverse/ fast-forward) DVD Recorder Information Troubleshooting 3 Pause Pause Pause Pause Pause Pause – 2 SOURCE ON SOURCE OFF Stop Power on Power off Stop Power on Power off Stop – – Stop – – Stop Power on Power off Stop – – Stop – – MENU u i o p ENTER Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting – – – – – – Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting – – – SETUP/SEARCH Set up Set up – – Set up – RETURN Return Return – – Cancel – CH + / SHUFFLE – – – – Switch channels – CH – / REPEAT – – – – Switch channels – 0 ~ 9, +10 Special Remarks Select track Select track Select track Select track – q – q Menu Cursor Enter Page forward screen / Browse/ Remote mode switching (Press and hold) Return 1-track/album shuffle play 1-track/All-track repeat play – – Buttons [0 ~ 9, +10] q, w q GSpecial RemarksH qOnly one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared. wThe names of the functions for the DVD remote control buttons differ from brand to brand. Check beforehand. NOTE •Preset a DVD player or DVD recorder for the DVD ( ) mode. Preset a CD player or CD recorder for the DVD ( •Preset a VCR for the VCR ( ) mode. Preset a tape deck for the VCR ( ) mode. ) mode. 52 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 56 2007/09/28 11:41:47 ENGLISH [MODE SELECTOR] [0 ~ 9, +10] [TV/VCR] TV (SONY) SAT SAT Punch through Punch through Punch through Punch through Power on Power off Power on Power off Power on Power off MENU u i o p ENTER SETUP DISPLAY CH + / – 0 ~ 9, +10 TV/VCR Special Remarks Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting Set up Display Switch channels Channel selection Switch inputs q, e Power on Power off Buttons Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting Set up Display Switch channels Channel selection Switch inputs q, e Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting Set up Display Switch channels Channel selection – q, e Menu/guide Cursor Enter setting Set up Display Switch channels Channel selection – q, e EL Display [MODE SELECTOR] EL Display [SEARCH] [CH +/–] [1 ~ 8] TU Troubleshooting [A ~ G], [d f], [BAND], [MODE], [MEMO] MODE SELECTOR Device Mode Device operated A~G d f BAND MODE MEMO SEARCH CH + / – 1~8 SHIFT Information GSpecial RemarksH qOnly one component can be preset for each mode. If a new code is preset, the previous code is automatically cleared. eThe CD, VCR or DVD buttons (one only set) can be assigned to the TV, satellite receiver and cable TV mode (vpage 55 “Punch Through Function”). Multi-Zone Buttons TV (HITACHI) Remote Control [CH +/–] Device operated 1 8 9 6 7 3 2 SOURCE ON SOURCE OFF Playback [ENTER] [uiop] [DISPLAY] Satellite Receiver / Cable TV Device Mode Setup [SETUP] [1], [8 9], [6 7], [3], [2], [SOURCE ON], [SOURCE OFF] TV Connections [MENU] MODE SELECTOR Getting Started EL Display EL Display Analog tuner Preset memory block selection Tuning + / – AM/FM switching Switch search modes Preset memory registration Buttons RDS search Preset channel selection Preset channel selection (1 ~ 8) Switch memory block [SHIFT] Buttons 53 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 57 2007/09/28 11:41:48 ENGLISH Getting Started [ AMP] [ TU] [SYSTEM CALL] Signal transmission indicator [MODE SELECTOR] [ iPod] 3 Refer to the table at the below, and use [NUMBER] to input the 5-digit number corresponding to the remote ID to be changed. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Connections 4 5 Press [TU] ( to be set. mode) or [iPod] to select the mode 4 Press the button to be set. The main remote control unit’s display turns off. bIf a button that cannot be learned is pressed, the signal transmission indicator lights but the signal is not learned. 5 Point the main remote control units directly at each Repeat steps 2 to 4 to set the remote IDs for all Setup [POWER ON] Playback Remote Control 1 (Default) 81001 2 3 4 [RC SETUP] iPod (Analog TUNER) Remote ID [NUMBER] Other device’s remote control unit TUNER AMP (MAIN) [CHANNEL +/–] 52863 72815 82001 52795 72816 83001 52800 72817 84001 52805 72818 Multi-Zone NOTE Information [ TV] Troubleshooting [8], [9], [6], [7], [1], [3], [2] Setting the Remote ID When using multiple DENON AV receivers in the same room, make this setting so that only the desired AV receiver operates. 1 2 Press [AMP] to set the main remote control unit to the AMP mode. Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. •When changing a setting, be sure to set the same remote ID as the AVR-2808’s (vpage 32). •When changing the AMP mode’s remote ID, also change the “TUNER” and “iPod” remote ID at the same time. •Set the remote ID of an analog tuner for TUNER ( ). Learning Function If your AV devices are of a brand other than DENON or if they cannot be operated with the preset memory function, their remote control signals can be transfered to stored in the AVR2808’s main remote control unit. 1 2 3 Once learning is completed normally, the display lights and the signal transmission indicator flashes twice. modes. MODE SELECTOR Press set. other and press and hold the button on the other device’s remote control unit that you want to learn. [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. AVR-2808’s main remote control unit (RC-1068) bIf you want to learn other buttons, repeat steps 4 and 5. bThe mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR]. bThe signal transmission indicator lights once for a long time if learning was not possible 6 Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting is completed. •With some remote control units, the signals cannot be learned or the device will not operate properly even when the signals have been learned. In this case, use the device’s own remote control unit. •Learned buttons have priority over the preset memory. If you no longer need the learned setting, reset the learning function (vpage 56). NOTE •[HOME] cannot be learned. •Do not learn any remote control signals at [RC SETUP]. •The AMP, ZONE2, ZONE3, ZONE4 and SYSTEM CALL modes cannot be learned. Press [9], [7] and [5], in that order. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the learning mode is set. 54 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 58 2007/09/28 11:41:49 ENGLISH [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to register. Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order. Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which you want to register the signals. Press the buttons you want to register in the same 6 Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the backlight on time setting mode is set. 3 Set the light on time. Punch Through Function CD, DVD or VCR mode buttons can be stored at unused TV or SAT/CBL mode buttons. For example, when DVD mode buttons are assigned to the TV mode, the DVD mode operations can be performed while in the TV mode. 1 2 3 [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to punch through (CD, DVD or VCR). Press Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order. 4 5 6 The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the punch through setting mode is set. Press the button you want to punch through (1, 2, 6, 7, 8, 9 or 3). [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to punch through (TV or SAT/CBL). Press The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. [Settable times] :[1] : 5 sec. [2] : 10 sec. (Default) [3] : 15 sec. [4] : 20 sec. [5] : 25 sec. Adjusting the Backlight’s Brightness The display’s brightness can be adjusted in 5 steps. (Default: Step 3) 1 2 Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [CHANNEL +] or [CHANNEL –]. The display gets one step brighter when [+] is pressed. The display gets one step darker when [–] is pressed. 3 Press [RC SETUP] to complete the setting. Troubleshooting The signal transmission indicator lights when a button is pressed. Example :Press [POWER ON]. ↓ Press [MODE SELECTOR] – [DVD]. ↓ Press [1]. bThe mode can be switched by pressing [MODE SELECTOR]. bPerform the registration procedure for all the buttons you want to register. Press [9], [7] and [3], in that order. Information sequence as the operations you want to perform. The registered signals are transmitted in the registered sequence. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Multi-Zone 4 5 The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the system call registration mode is set. were registered. Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. Remote Control The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) at which the signals 1 2 Playback 1 2 3 Press Press Setting the Time the Backlight Stays Lit Setup Registering 1 2 Press [AMP], to select “SYSTEM CALL”. Connections This function lets you register a series of operations at a single button. For example, the amplifier can be turned on, the input source selected, the monitor’s power turned on, the source device’s power turned on and the play mode set all by pressing a single button. Up to 32 signals each can be registered at [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3). Calling out Getting Started System Call Function Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting is completed. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice and the setting is completed. 55 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 59 2007/09/28 11:41:50 ENGLISH Getting Started Signal transmission indicator [MODE SELECTOR] GResetting by device modeH 1 2 3 4 Press reset. [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. [SYSTEM CALL] Connections The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. All Settings Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. 1 2 The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [9], [8] and [1], in that order. The signal transmission indicator flashes 4 times. All the settings are restored to their defaults. Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Setup Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to reset twice. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Playback Remote Control System Call Function Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. [NUMBER] [RC SETUP] Multi-Zone Information 1 2 3 4 The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [9], [7] and [8], in that order. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [SYSTEM CALL] (1, 2 or 3) you want to reset. Resetting the Main Remote Control Unit Learning Function GResetting button by buttonH Troubleshooting 1 2 3 4 Press reset. [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [9], [7] and [6], in that order. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press the button you want to reset twice. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Punch-Through Function Press [MODE SELECTOR] for the device you want to reset (TV or SAT/CBL). 1 2 3 4 Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press [9], [8] and [4], in that order. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. Press and hold in [RC SETUP] for at least 3 seconds. The signal transmission indicator flashes twice. 56 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 60 2007/09/28 11:41:51 ENGLISH [RANDOM] The amp assign function lets you assign the amplifiers for the different channels built into the AVR-2808 to the speaker outputs for the different zones. Select the desired playback environment from among “Setting 1” to “Setting 4”, then set the corresponding “Amp Assign” mode at menu “Manual Setup” – “Option Setup” – “Amp Assign” (vpage 31). Connect the speakers as described at “Amp Assign” mode settings and speakers connected to the various speaker terminals. Information “Setting 2” is possible to switch the Amp Assign mode between the 5.1-channel mode and 2-channel mode without changing the speaker connections. Multi-Zone Troubleshooting Switching the zone to be operated Power off Power on Switching the input source Volume control Channel + / – Tuning + / – Muting Switching the memory block Auto search (cue) Stop Play / Pause 1-track / All -track repeat play 1-track / album shuffle play Multi-zone Settings with the Amp Assign Function Remote Control ZONE SELECT POWER OFF POWER ON SOURCE SELECT VOLUME + / – CHANNEL + / – TUNING + / – MUTE SHIFT 8 9 2 1/3 REPEAT RANDOM [VOLUME+ / –] [MUTE] [SHIFT] NOTE •For bi-amp playback, use speakers compatible with that type of connection. •When conducting bi-amp playback, remove the short-circuiting boards (or wires) from the speaker terminals. Playback [CHANNEL+ / –] [TUNING+ / –] [8],[9], [1/3],[2] [REPEAT] [POWER ON] [SOURCE SELECT] The AVR-2808 is compatible with the following types of playback: •Multi-zone playback (ZONE2 & ZONE3) •Bi-amp playback (front speakers) Setup [ZONE SELECT] [POWER OFF] Amp Assign / Multi-zone Connections and Operations Connections The sub remote control unit (RC-1071) included with the AVR-2808 can be used as the exclusive multizone remote control unit. bThe following describes operation for the selected zone. (Use [ZONE SELECT] to switch zones.) •Turning the multi-zone power on and off •Selecting the input source to be played •Adjusting and temporarily muting the multi-zone volume •Listening to the tuner Getting Started Sub Remote Control Unit bWhen using a Control Dock for iPod (ASD-1R), [FAVORITES DIRECT PLAY] cannot be used. 57 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 61 2007/09/28 11:41:52 ENGLISH Getting Started Setting 1 : F7.1-channel Setting 3 : playback FMulti-zone playback •5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 or ZONE3 stereo playback •5.1-channel playback + ZONE2 + ZONE3 monaural playback Main zone FL SW C FR Connections Main zone FL SW Amp Assign mode: 7.1ch SL SR C + 7.1ch (Default) Setup 5.1ch SL SBL ZONE3 ZONE2 FR SR SBR + Playback + Z2L Z2R + Stereo Z2L Z2R + Z2 + Mono Z3L Amp Assign mode: Z3R ZONE2 Z3L Z3R ZONE3 Stereo Z3 ZONE2/3-MONO Mono Remote Control nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker terminals Speaker terminal Amp Assign mode 7.1ch FRONT R L FR FL SURR. BACK / AMP ASSIGN SURR CENTER C R L R L SR SL SBR SBL Multi-Zone Setting 2 : With this setting it is possible to switch between the following two playback modes. Information F5.1-channel playback 2-channel Switching·················Surround Mode switching playback Main zone FL L C R FL Troubleshooting Surround Mode SW 5.1ch SL L Multi Channel / Surround R FR Speaker terminal SL Amp Assign mode: 2ch FRONT R L ZONE2 Z2R Z2L ZONE3 Z3R Z3L FR L SURR. BACK / AMP ASSIGN SURR CENTER R ZONE2/3-MONO SW DIRECT / STEREO SR C nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker terminals Amp Assign mode Main zone FR “STEREO” or “MONO” depends on the setting at menu “Manual Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Zone Setup” – “Channel” (vpage 30). FL R C SR L SL Z3 Z2 (MONO) (MONO) 2ch SR nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker terminals Speaker terminal Amp Assign mode 2ch FRONT R L FR FL C SURR. BACK / AMP ASSIGN SURR CENTER R L R L SR SL FR FL 58 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 62 2007/09/28 11:41:53 ENGLISH FMaking bi-amp connections for the FL and FR channels in the main zone and conducting 5.1-channel playback (switching with other modes not possible) FL SW 5.1ch FL/FR Bi-Amp FR Connectors for audio output Audio signals Connectors for video output ZONE2 ZONE2 PRE OUT Stereo ZONE2 VIDEO OUT ZONE3 ZONE3 PRE OUT Stereo – Amp Assign mode: SR Front A Bi-Amp Main zone (7.1-channel system) ZONE2 Monitor Front B Bi-Amp Monitor 48 '3 Power amplifier $ Speaker terminal FRONT-B R R L CENTER L SURR R L Front A Bi-Amp Front B Bi-Amp FL-A FR-B FL-B C SR SL Input ZONE2 audio output SURR. BACK / AMP ASSIGN R L FR FL FL-A/FR-A Bi-Amp connection FR FL FL-B/FR-B Bi-Amp connection 43 4- Remote control unit 4# - 4# 3 ZONE3 Power amplifier ZONE3 audio output Information FR-A AVR-2808 DVD player Multi-Zone Amp Assign mode FRONT-A ZONE2 video output Remote Control nAmp Assign mode setting and speakers connected to the various speaker terminals Playback '- Setup SL C Prepare power amplifiers for ZONE2 and ZONE3. Connections Main zone Multi-zone and Operations with Zone Pre-out controlSettings unit Output Getting Started Remote Setting 4 : : Multi-zone video cable : Multi-zone audio cable Troubleshooting •When only using one speaker for ZONE2 or ZONE3, set to “Mono”. In this case, the ZONE2 (ZONE3) monaural output is output from the ZONE2 (ZONE3) pre-out L and R connectors, so connect as desired. •Separate power amplifiers are needed for ZONE2 and ZONE3. 59 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 63 2007/09/28 11:41:54 ENGLISH Getting Started SOURCE SELECT <ZONE3 ON/OFF> VOLUME Multi-zone Operations Turning the Power On and Off Connections GOperation on the main unitH Press <ZONE2 ON/OFF> or <ZONE3 ON/OFF> for the zone to be operated. When the power turns on, the multi-zone indicator ( or ) lights on the display. GOperation on the remote control unitH Setup In the zone mode you want to operate, press [ON] or [OFF]. Playback <ZONE2 ON/OFF> <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> Selecting the Input Source GOperation on the main unitH Remote Control [ q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted. w Turn <SOURCE SELECT>. AMP] GOperation on the remote control unitH In the zone mode you want to operate, press [SOURCE SELECT]. [ON] [OFF] [ON] [OFF] Multi-Zone VOLUME Information (ZONE2 mode) SOURCE SELECT (ZONE3 mode) [MUTE] Turning off the Sound Temporarily In the zone mode for which you want to mute the sound, press [MUTE]. The sound is reduced to the level set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Mute Level” (vpage 30). To cancel, either adjust the volume or press [MUTE] again. The setting is canceled when the zone’s power is turned off. The source selected for ZONE2 is also output from the recording output connectors. NOTE •When the input source to which the digital input connectors (OPTICAL/COAXIAL) are assigned is selected in ZONE2 or ZONE3, playback is only possible if the digital signal being input is in PCM (2-channel) format. •Digital audio signals input from the HDMI connectors cannot be played in multi-zone. •When certain digital signals are being input, noise may be output from the ZONE2 and ZONE3 audio output connectors. Adjusting the Volume GOperation on the main unitH q Press <ZONE2/3 / REC SELECT> and select the zone to be adjusted. w Turn <VOLUME> to adjust. GOperation on the remote control unitH In the zone mode whose volume you want to adjust, press [VOLUME]. [Variable range] ––– –70dB ~ –40dB ~ +18dB Troubleshooting (Main remote control unit) [OFF] [ON] SOURCE SELECT The volume can be adjusted when menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Level” is set to “VAR”. The volume can be increased up to the value set at menu “Manual Setup” – “Zone Setup” – “(select the zone)” – “Volume Limit” (vpage 30). [MUTE] (Sub remote control unit) About the button names in these explanations < > : Buttons on the main unit [ ] : Buttons on the remote control unit Button name only: Buttons on the main unit and remote control unit 60 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 64 2007/09/28 11:41:55 ENGLISH We recommend installing the speakers for the surround “L” and “R” channels a bit forward. Path of the surround sound from the speakers to the listening position We recommend using 2 speakers. When using dipolar speakers in particular, be sure to use 2 speakers. Other Information About Speaker Installation Surround back speakers 48 $ '3 Below we introduce examples of speaker layouts. Refer to these to arrange your speakers according to their type and how you want to use them. 60 to 90 cm qWhen mainly playing movies Recommended when your surround speakers are single or 2-way speakers. '3 Monitor Subwoofer Front speaker 60 to 90 cm Point slightly downwards 60° 45° ~ 60° Surround speaker 4-DI Surround back speaker Front speaker 60 to 90 cm Surround back speakers GAs seen from aboveH Surround speaker GAs seen from the sideH Point slightly downwards Troubleshooting $ Surround back speaker Information 48 Multi-Zone '- GAs seen from the sideH Front speakers Center speaker Surround speaker Movement of acoustic image from SR to SL Change of positioning and acoustic image with 6.1-channel systems Surround back speakers eWhen playing movies and music 60° Surround speakers Point slightly downwards 60° GAs seen from aboveH Monitor Subwoofer 43DI Surround back speaker Front speaker G1H Using surround back speaker(s) Front speakers Center speaker 4-DI Surround speaker Surround speakers Remote Control '- Examples of speaker layouts Playback Change of positioning and acoustic image with 5.1-channel systems Setup Sound positioning directly to the rear can be achieved easily by adding a surround back speaker to a 5.1-channel system. In addition, the acoustic image extending between the sides and the rear is narrowed, thus greatly improving the expression of the surround signals for sounds moving from the sides to the back and from the front to the point directly behind the listening position. Connections Placement of the surround left and right channels when using surround back speakers wSetting for primarily watching movies using diffusion type speakers for the surround speakers For the greatest sense of surround sound envelopment, diffuse radiation speakers such as bipolar types, or dipolar types, provide a wider dispersion than is possible to obtain from a direct radiating speaker (monopolar). Place these speakers at either side of the prime listening position, mounted above ear level. Getting Started Number of surround back speakers 43DI Surround back speaker seen from aboveH GAs GAs seen from the sideH 4#DI Movement of acoustic image from SR to SB to SL In addition to sources recorded in 6.1-channels, the surround effect of conventional 2- to 5.1-channel sources can also be enhanced. 61 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 65 2007/09/28 11:41:56 ENGLISH Getting Started G2H When not using surround back speakers Front speakers Center speaker Dolby TrueHD is a high definition audio technology developed by Dolby Laboratories, using lossless coding technology to faithfully reproduce the sound of the studio master. This format is compatible with a maximum sampling frequency of 96 kHz and up to 7.1-channels, so it is used for applications particularly prioritizing sound quality. Connections Monitor Subwoofer 60° Surround speaker Front speaker Setup 60 to 90 cm Playback 120° Surround speakers Remote Control GAs seen from aboveH Dolby TrueHD GAs seen from the sideH Surround Multi-Zone The AVR-2808 is equipped with a digital signal processing circuit that lets you play program sources in the surround mode to achieve the same sense of presence as in a movie theater. Dolby Surround Information Dolby Digital Troubleshooting Dolby Digital is a multichannel digital signal format developed by Dolby Laboratories. A total of 5.1-channels are played: 3 front channels (“FL” , “FR” and “C”), 2 surround channels (“SL” and “SR”) and the “LFE” channel for low frequencies. Because of this, there is no crosstalk between channels and a realistic sound field with a “three-dimensional” feeling (sense of distance, movement and positioning) is achieved. A real, overpowering sense of presence is achieved when playing movie sources in AV rooms as well. Dolby Digital Plus Dolby Digital Plus is an improved Dolby Digital signal format that is compatible with up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound and also improves sound quality thanks to extra data bit rate performance. It is upwardly compatible with conventional Dolby Digital, so it offers greater flexibility in response to the source signal and the conditions of the playback equipment. DTS Surround DTS Digital Surround DTS Digital Surround is the standard digital surround format of DTS, Inc., compatible with a sampling frequency of 44.1 or 48 kHz and up to 5.1-channels of digital discrete surround sound. Dolby Pro Logic g DTS-HD High Resolution Audio Dolby Pro Logic g is a matrix decoding technology developed by Dolby Laboratories. Regular music such as that on CDs is encoded into 5-channels to achieve an excellent surround effect. The surround channel signals are converted into stereo and full band signals (with a frequency response of 20 Hz to 20 kHz or greater) to create a “three-dimensional” sound image offering a rich sense of presence for all stereo sources. DTS-HD High Resolution Audio is an improved version of the conventional DTS, DTS-ES and DTS 96/24 signals formats, compatible with sampling frequencies of 96 or 48 kHz and up to 7.1-channels of discrete digital sound. High data bit rate performance provides high quality sound. This format is fully compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data. Dolby Pro Logic gx Dolby Pro Logic gx is a further improved version of the Dolby Pro Logic g matrix decoding technology. Audio signals recorded in 2-channels are decoded to achieve a natural sound with up to 7.1-channels. There are 3 modes: “Music” suited for playing music, “Cinema” suited for playing movies, and “Game” which is optimized for playing games. bSources recorded in Dolby Surround Sources recorded in Dolby Surround are indicated with the following logo marks. Dolby Surround support mark : Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby”, “Pro Logic” and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. DTS-HD Master Audio DTS-HD Master Audio is DTS, Inc’s lossless audio format compatible with up to 96 kHz/7.1-channels. The lossless audio coding technology faithfully reproduces the sound of the studio master. It is fully compatible with conventional products, including conventional DTS digital surround 5.1-channel data. DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 DTS-ES™ Discrete 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format adding a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible according to the decoder. DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 DTS-ES™ Matrix 6.1 is a 6.1-channel discrete digital audio format inserting a surround back (SB) channel to the DTS digital surround sound through matrix encoding. Decoding of conventional 5.1-channel audio signals is also possible according to the decoder. DTS NEO:6™ Surround DTS NEO:6™ is a matrix decoding technology for achieving 6.1channel surround playback with 2-channel sources. It includes “DTS NEO:6 CINEMA” suited for playing movies and “DTS NEO:6 MUSIC” suited for playing music. 62 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 66 2007/09/28 11:41:57 ENGLISH DTS 96/24 is a digital audio format enabling high sound quality playback in 5.1-channels with a sampling frequency of 96 kHz and 24 bit quantization on DVD-Video. HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia Interface) HDMI is a digital interface standard for next generation TVs based on DVI (Digital Visual Interface) standards and optimized for use in consumer equipment. Non-compressed digital video and multi-channel audio signals are transmitted with a single connection. HDMI is also compatible with HDCP (High-bandwidth Digital Contents Protection), a technology for protecting copyrights that encrypts digital video signals in the same was as with DVI. Remote Control Multi-Zone Deep Color Eliminates on-screen color banding, for smooth tonal transitions and subtle gradations between colors. Enables increased contrast ratio. Can represent many times more shades of gray between black and white. At 30-bit pixel depth, a four times improvement would be the minimum, and the typical improvement would be eight times or more. Information Troubleshooting Audyssey MultEQ® XT is a trademark of Audyssey Laboratories. It is licensed under U.S. and National Patent Applications 20030235318 and 10/700,220. Additional U.S. and Foreign Patents pending. MultEQ XT and the Audyssey MultEQ XT logo are trademarks of Audyssey Laboratories, Inc. All rights reserved. “HDMI”, “HDMI logo” and “High-Definition Multimedia Interface” are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC. Playback Audyssey MultEQ® XT is the first technology to properly measure sound information throughout a listening area, then combine this information to accurately represent the acoustical problems in the room. Based on these measurements, MultEQ XT calculates an equalization solution that corrects for both time and frequency response problems in every seat. Audyssey MultEQ XT not only corrects frequency response problem in a large listening area, it also performs a fully automated surround system setup. For a detailed description, see page 23. Because consumer electronics devices are using increasingly complex digital signal processing to enhance the clarity and detail of the content, synchronization of video and audio in user devices has become a greater challenge and could potentially require complex enduser adjustments. HDMI 1.3 incorporates an automatic video/audio synching capability that allows devices to perform this synchronization automatically with total accuracy. Setup Audyssey MultEQ® XT AL24 Processing for All Channels DENON has further developed its proprietary AL24 Processing, an analog waveform reproduction technology, to support the 192-kHz sampling frequency of DVD-Audio. AL24 Processing Plus, thoroughly suppresses quantization noise associated with D/A conversion of LPCM signals to reproduce the low-level signals with optimum clarity that will bring out all the delicate nuances of the music. Equipped foe not only front left and right channels but also for the surround left and right, center and subwoofer channels. Lip Sync Connections Manufactured under license under U.S. Patent #’s: 5,451,942; 5,956,674; 5,974,380; 5,978,762; 6,226,616; 6,487,535 & other U.S. and worldwide patents issued & pending. DTS is a registered trademark and the DTS logos, Symbol, DTS-HD and DTS-HD Master Audio are trademarks of DTS, Inc.© 1996-2007 DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved. AL24 Processing Plus Getting Started DTS 96/24 xvYCC Next-generation “xvYCC” color space supports 1.8 times as many colors as existing HDTV signals. Lets HDTVs display colors more accurately. Enables displays with natural, vivid colors. 63 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 67 2007/09/28 11:41:57 ENGLISH Getting Started Surround Modes and Parameters Signals and adjustability in the different modes Channel output Surround mode Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses) Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Front L/R Center Surround L/R Surround Back L/R PURE DIRECT, DIRECT S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A DSD DIRECT S A A A A A A A A DSD MULTI DIRECT S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) A MULTI CH DIRECT S D D D D A S ( 0 dB) STEREO S A A A D S (OFF) EXT. IN S D D D D MULTI CH IN S D D D WIDE SCREEN S D D DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx S D DOLBY PRO LOGIC g S DTS NEO:6 Subwoofer D. COMP LFE AFDM Multi-Zone Information MODE ROOM SIZE LEVEL DELAY TIME Subwoofer A A A A A S A A A A A S S A A A A A A S (ON) S A A A A A A S ( 0 dB) A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A D A S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S A A A A A A D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S S (OFF) A A S (ON, 10) A A D D D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE1) S (CINEMA) A A A A D D A D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE2) S (CINEMA) A A A A S D D D D S (OFF) A A S S (NOTE1) S (CINEMA) A A A A DOLBY DIGITAL S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S S (OFF) A A A A A DTS SURROUND S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) S (ON) S S (OFF) A A A A A 7CH STEREO S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A A A A A SUPER STADIUM S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A S (medium) S (10) A A ROCK ARENA S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A S (medium) S (10) A A JAZZ CLUB S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A S (medium) S (10) A A CLASSIC CONCERT S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A S (medium) S (10) A A MONO MOVIE S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A S (medium) S (10) A A VIDEO GAME S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A S (medium) S (10) A A MATRIX S D D D D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A S A A A A S (30 ms) A VIRTURL S A A A D S (OFF) S ( 0 dB) A A A A A A A A Troubleshooting S: Signal / Adjustable A : No signal / Not adjustable D:Turned on or off by speaker configuration setting z1 z2 z1 SB CH OUT CINEMA EQ. S: Signal / Adjustable A : No signal / Not adjustable NOTE1 :This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” (vpage 38). NOTE2 :This parameter is availabe when the menu “Parameter” – “Surround Parameter” – “MODE” is set to “CINEMA” or “PL” (vpage 38). NOTE: z1 :When playing Dolby Digital and DTS signals. z2 :When playing Dolby Digital, DTS, DVD-Audio and Super Audio CD. 64 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 68 2007/09/28 11:41:58 ENGLISH Getting Started Signals and adjustability in the different modes Parameter (default values are shown in parentheses) Surround mode PRO LOGIC g/gx MUSIC mode only NEO:6 MUSIC mode only EXT. IN only S (OFF) S (NOTE5) S A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S (OFF) S (NOTE5) A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S A A A A S A A A A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx S (OFF) S (3) S (3) A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g S (OFF) S (3) S (3) A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S DTS NEO:6 A A A S (0.3) A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S DOLBY DIGITAL A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A DTS SURROUND A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) A 7CH STEREO A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S SUPER STADIUM A A A A A S (NOTE3) S (OFF) S (OFF) S ROCK ARENA A A A A A S (NOTE4) S (OFF) S (OFF) S JAZZ CLUB A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S CLASSIC CONCERT A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S MONO MOVIE A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S VIDEO GAME A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S MATRIX A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S VIRTURL A A A A A S (0 dB) S (OFF) S (OFF) S A A A A DSD DIRECT A A A A DSD MULTI DIRECT A A A MULTI CH DIRECT A A STEREO A EXT. IN MULTI CH IN WIDE SCREEN Information A A PURE DIRECT, DIRECT Multi-Zone A SW ATT Remote Control RESTORER CENTER IMAGE Playback Room EQ CENTER WIDTH Setup Night Mode DIMENSION Connections Tone Control PANORAMA Troubleshooting S: Adjustable A : Not adjustable NOTE3 :BASS +6 dB, TREBLE 0 dB NOTE4 :BASS +6 dB, TREBLE +4 dB NOTE5 : Can be used according to the “Direct Mode Setup” setting. 65 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 69 2007/09/28 11:41:59 ENGLISH Getting Started Differences in Surround Mode Names Depending on the Input Signals Input signals Button DTS Surround mode Note Connections ANALOG LINEAR PCM DTS ES DSCRT (With Flag) DOLBY DIGITAL DTS ES MTRX (With Flag) DTS (5.1ch) DTS 96/24 DOLBY DIGITAL EX (With Flag) DOLBY DIGITAL EX (With no Flag) DVD-AUDIO DOLBY DIGITAL (5.1/5/4ch) DOLBY DIGITAL (4/3ch) DOLBY DVD-Audio DIGITAL (multi ch) (2ch) Super Audio CD DVDAudio (2ch) DSD (multi ch) DSD (2ch) STANDARD DTS SURROUND Setup A A F D A A A A A A A A A A A A DTS ES MTRX6.1 z1 A A A F D A A A A A A A A A A A DTS SURROUND A A S S F A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A F A A A A A A A A A DTS 96/24 DTS + PLgx CINEMA z2 A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A DTS + PLgx MUSIC z1 A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A Remote Control z1 Playback DTS ES DSCRT6.1 DTS + NEO:6 z1 A A A S S S A A A A A A A A A DTS NEO:6 CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DTS NEO:6 MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S A A A A A A S S S S A A A A A A A A A A A S F F F A A A A A A DOLBY SURROUND DOLBY DIGITAL EX z1 DOLBY DIGITAL Multi-Zone DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx CINEMA z2 A A A A A A F D S S S A A A A DOLBY DIGITAL + PLgx MUSIC z1 A A A A A A S S S S A A A A A DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A F A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S Information DOLBY PRO LOGIC gx GAME S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g CINEMA S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g MUSIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S DOLBY PRO LOGIC g GAME S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S Troubleshooting DOLBY PRO LOGIC S S A A A A A A A A S A S A S MULTI CH IN MULTI CH IN A A A A A A A A A A A F A F A MULTI IN + PLgx CINEMA z2 A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A MULTI IN + PLgx MUSIC z1 A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A A A A A A A A A A A A F D (7.1) A A A MULTI CH IN 7.1 NOTE: z1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None” . z2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None” . F : Mode selectable in initial status D : Mode fixed when “AFDM” is “ON” S : Selectable mode A : Non-selectable mode 66 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 70 2007/09/28 11:42:00 ENGLISH DTS Note DOLBY DIGITAL Super Audio CD DTS 96/24 DOLBY DIGITAL EX (With no Flag) DOLBY DIGITAL (5.1/5/4ch) DOLBY DIGITAL (4/3ch) S S S S S S S A S A S A A A A A A A A A A S A A A A A A A A A A S A A A A A A A A A A S A S A ANALOG DTS ES DSCRT (With Flag) DTS ES MTRX (With Flag) DTS (5.1ch) DIRECT S S S S DSD DIRECT A A A A DSD MULTI DIRECT A A A MULTI CH DIRECT A A Surround mode DVD-AUDIO DOLBY DIGITAL EX (With Flag) LINEAR PCM DOLBY DVDDIGITAL Audio (2ch) (multi ch) DVDAudio (2ch) DSD DSD (2ch) (multi ch) A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A M DIRECT + PLgx MUSIC z1 A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A PURE DIRECT S S S S S S S S S S S A S A S DSD PURE DIRECT A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S DSD MULTI PURE A A A A A A A A A A A A A S A MULTI CH PURE DIRECT A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A M DIRECT 7.1 Playback z2 Setup M DIRECT + PLgx CINEMA Connections DIRECT PURE DIRECT z2 A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A M PURE D + PLgx MUSIC z1 A A A A A A A A A A A S A S A A A A A A A A A A A A S A A A Multi-Zone M CH PURE DIRECT 7.1 Remote Control M PURE D + PLgx CINEMA DSP SIMULATION 7CH STEREO z3 S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S SUPER STADIUM S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S ROCK ARENA S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S JAZZ CLUB S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S CLASSIC CONCERT S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S MONO MOVIE S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S VIDEO GAME S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S MATRIX S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S VIRTUAL S S S S S S S S S S S S S S S F F S S S S S S S S S S F S F Troubleshooting S S Information S WIDE SCREEN STEREO STEREO Getting Started Input signals Button NOTE : z1: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “None” . z2: This mode is not available when the surround back speaker setup is set to “1spkr” or “None” . z3: If the surround back speaker setup is set to “None” , then “5CH STEREO” is displayed. F : Mode selectable in initial status S : Selectable mode A : Non-selectable mode 67 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 71 2007/09/28 11:42:01 ENGLISH Getting Started Relationship Between Video Signals and Monitor Output Video convert Connections Setup Playback ON Remote Control Multi-Zone HDMI A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A A S S S S S S S S S S S S S Input signals COMPONENT A A A A S (1080p) S (480p ~ 720p) S (480i / 576i) S (1080p) S (480p ~ 720p) S (480i / 576i) S (1080p) S (480p ~ 720p) S (480i / 576i) S (1080p) S (480p ~ 720p) S (480i / 576i) A A A A S (Other than 480i / 576i) S (480i / 576i) S (1080p) S (480p ~ 720p) S (480i / 576i) S (Other than 480i / 576i) S (480i / 576i) S (Other than 480i / 576i) S (480i / 576i) Information S: Signal input A : No signal 480p ~ 720p: 480p / 576p / 1080i / 720p S-VIDEO A A S S A A A A A A S S S S S S A A S S A A A A A S S S S VIDEO A S A S A A A S S S A A A S S S A S A S A A S S S A A S S HDMI A VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO A COMPONENT COMPONENT VIDEO COMPONENTz1 COMPONENTz1 S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 COMPONENTz2 HDMI HDMIz1 HDMIz2 HDMIz2 HDMI HDMI HDMIz1 HDMIz1 HDMIz1 HDMIz2 HDMIz2 HDMIz2 HDMIz2 MONITOR OUT COMPONENT S-VIDEO A A VIDEO VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO COMPONENT A COMPONENT A COMPONENT COMPONENT z COMPONENT 1 VIDEO COMPONENTz1 A z COMPONENT 1 COMPONENT z COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO z COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO z COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO z COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO z COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO A A VIDEO VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO COMPONENT A COMPONENT COMPONENT z COMPONENT 1 VIDEO COMPONENTz1 A COMPONENTz1 COMPONENT COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO VIDEO A VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO A A COMPONENT VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO A VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO A COMPONENT VIDEO VIDEO VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO S-VIDEO A : Not output z1: On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output. z2: On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output. Troubleshooting COMPONENT or HDMI : On-screen display only displayed for MENU button and the main remote control unit’s PARA button. • The main zone video conversion function is compatible with the following format: NTSC, PAL, SECAM, NTSC4.43, PAL-N, PAL-M and PAL-60. • When SECAM signals of video input are up-converted, the signals are output in PAL format from the S-Video connector. • When the input signal is a component 1080i or 720p signal, the signal upconverted to HDMI is output with that resolution or 1080p. • When the input signal is a video, S-Video or component 480i, 480p, 576i or 576p signals, the signal up-converted to HDMI is output according to the setting made at “Resolution” under “HDMI Setup” – “HDMI Video Setup” (vpage 28). 68 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 72 2007/09/28 11:42:02 ENGLISH MONITOR OUT HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO VIDEO A A A A VIDEO A A A S-VIDEO A A A S-VIDEO VIDEOz2 A A — VIDEO A A COMPONENT A A A z COMPONENT 1 VIDEO A A z COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO A A COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO VIDEOz2 A z COMPONENT 1 — VIDEO A HDMI A A A HDMI VIDEO A A HDMI S-VIDEO A A HDMI S-VIDEO VIDEOz2 A HDMI — VIDEO A HDMI COMPONENT A A z HDMI COMPONENT 1 VIDEO A z HDMI COMPONENT 2 S-VIDEO A HDMI COMPONENTz2 S-VIDEO VIDEOz2 z HDMI COMPONENT 1 — VIDEO A : Not output z1: On-screen display superimposed on video signal and output. z2: On-screen display superimposed on S-Video signal and output. Playback Remote Control VIDEO A S A S S A S A S S A S A S S A S A S S Setup Input signals HDMI COMPONENT S-VIDEO A A A A A A A A S A A S A A S A S A A S A A S S A S S A S S S A A S A A S A S S A S S A S S S A S S A S S S S S S S S S S: Signal input A : No signal Connections OFF S-VIDEO MONITOR OUT — — — Used Not used — — — Used Not used — — — Used Not used — — — Used Not used Getting Started Video convert COMPONENT or HDMI: On-screen display only displayed for MENU button and the main remote control unit’s PARA button. Multi-Zone nZONE2 monitor out Input VIDEO A A A S S (VIDEO) S A S (S-VIDEO) S S VIDEO A Troubleshooting S: Signal present A: No signal Information Monitor out S-VIDEO S (S-VIDEO) S : Output present A : No output 69 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 73 2007/09/28 11:42:03 ENGLISH Getting Started Symptom Power turns off suddenly and power indicator flashes red. Troubleshooting Connections Setup If a problem should arise, first check the following: 1. Are the connections correct? 2. Is the set being operated as described in the owner’s manual? 3. Are the other components operating properly? If this unit does not operate properly, check the items listed in the table below. Should the problem persist, there may be a malfunction. In this case, disconnect the power immediately and contact your store of purchase. Playback GGeneralH Remote Control Symptom Power does not turn on, or turns off directly after it was turned on. No sound is produced from speakers. Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting Cause Countermeasure •Connection of the power cord is •Check that the power plugs are faulty. securely inserted into the AVR2808’s AC inlet and the wall power outlet. •Connection with the input •Check the connections. devices or connection of the speaker cables is faulty. •Device you want to play and set •Select an appropriate input input source do not match. source. •Master volume is turned too •Adjust the master volume to an low. appropriate level. •Mute mode is set. •Cancel the mute mode. •Headphones are connected. •Disconnect the headphones. •No digital signals are being •Select an input source for which input. the digital input setting has been made. •The connectors to which the •Set the input mode. digital inputs are assigned and the settable input modes do not match. Display is off. •The “Dimmer” setting is set to •Set to something other than “OFF”. “OFF”. •The PURE DIRECT mode is set. •Set a surround mode other than the PURE DIRECT mode. “DOLBY DIGITAL” •DVD player’s digital audio output •Check the DVD player’s audio indicator does not setting is not proper. output setting. For details, read appear on display. the DVD player’s operating instructions. Page 20 Cause Countermeasure •Protection circuit activated due •Turn off the power, wait for the to rise of internal temperature. set to fully cool down, then turn the power back on. •Place the set in a well-ventilated place. •Core wires of two speakers are •First unplug the power cord, touching each other or a core then twist the core wires tightly wire is sticking out of the terminal or terminate the speaker cables, and touching the set’s rear panel, then reconnect. activating the protection circuit. •Speakers with an impedance •Use speakers with the specified other than specified are being impedance. used. •Set is damaged. •Turn off the power and contact a DENON service center. Page 10 10 10 10 – GRemote Control UnitH 9 43 43 43 43 35 34 Symptom Cause Set does not work •Batteries are worn. properly when •You are operating outside of the remote control specified range. unit operated. •Obstacle between main unit and remote control unit. •The batteries are not inserted in the proper direction, as indicated by the polarity marks in the battery compartment. •The set’s remote control sensor is exposed to strong light (direct sunlight, inverter type fluorescent bulb light, etc.). •The remote ID of the main unit and remote control unit do not match. Countermeasure •Replace with new batteries. •Operate within the specified range. •Remove the obstacle. Page 3 3 •Insert the batteries in the proper direction, following the polarity marks in the battery compartment. •Move the set to a place in which the remote control sensor will not be exposed to strong light. 3 •Set the same remote IDs for the main unit and remote control unit. 32, 54 3 3 32 38 – 70 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 74 2007/09/28 11:42:03 ENGLISH 36 ~ 38 Cause Countermeasure •The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI • Set to “TV”. Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” – “HDMI Audio Out” setting is set to “AMP”. Page 27 GVideoH 31 •Set to something other than “None”. •Select a surround playback mode. •Turn on the subwoofer’s power. 26 Symptom No picture appears. 36 ~ 38 – 26 •Check the connections. 9 •Adjust the subwoofer’s volume to an appropriate level. •Set to the STANDARD mode. 49 37 34 DVDs cannot be copied on a VCR. 38 – •The connections to the HDMI connectors are faulty. •HDMI input setting is improper. •The monitor is not compatible with copyright protection (HDCP). •The HDMI format of the player and monitor do not match. •Input source does not match recorder’s video connection connector (video or S-Video). •Check the connections. 11 •Check the HDMI input setting. •Connect a monitor that is compatible with copyright protection (HDCP). •Match the HDMI format of the player and monitor. •The video conversion function does not work for the REC OUT connectors. Match the input source and recorder connections. •This is not a malfunction. Most movie software includes copy prevention signals and cannot be copied. 35 11 Countermeasure Page – 27 – 11 15 Troubleshooting – Picture cannot be recorded. •Cancel the PURE DIRECT mode. •High definition (1080i/720p) and progressive (480p/576p) video signals are not down-converted. Set the player to interlace (480i/576i) signals. •Set properly. Page 11 ~ 20 Information – No picture appears with HDMI connections. Countermeasure •Check the connections. Multi-Zone •Set to “Yes”. Cause •The connections between the AVR-2808 and monitor are faulty. •The monitor’s input setting is wrong. •PURE DIRECT mode is set. •The player is connected using the component input connectors, the monitor is connected using the video (yellow) or S-Video output connectors. Remote Control •Check the setting and change it as necessary. No test tones are produced when main remote control unit’s TEST TONE button is pressed. DTS sound is not •DVD player’s audio output setting •Set the DVD player. For details, output. is not set to bitstream. refer to the DVD player’s operating instructions. •DVD player is not compatible •Use a DTS-compatible player. with DTS sound playback. •The AVR-2808’s “Decode Mode” •Set to the “Auto” or “DTS” setting is set to “PCM”. mode. HDMI audio •The “Manual Setup” – “HDMI •Set to “AMP”. signals are not Setup” – “HDMI Audio Setup” output from – “HDMI Audio Out” setting is speakers. set to “TV”. Symptom No sound is output from the monitor connected with HDMI connections. Playback •The surround back speaker’s power amplifier is assigned to a different channel. •Surround back speaker setting is set to “None”. •Surround mode not set to a mode for 6.1- or 7.1-channel playback. •Subwoofer’s power not turned on. •The “Subwoofer” setting at “Speaker Configuration” is set to “No”. •The subwoofer is not properly connected. •The subwoofer’s volume is turned off. •Surround mode not set to “STANDARD”. Page 37 Setup No sound is produced from subwoofer. Cause Countermeasure •You are playing a monaural •The mode is set to something source (TV, AM radio broadcast, other than “STANDARD”. etc.) in the STANDARD mode. •The surround mode is set to •Set to a surround playback “STEREO”, “DIRECT” or “PURE mode. DIRECT”. Connections Symptom No sound is produced from center speaker. No sound is produced from surround speakers. No sound is produced from surround back speaker. Getting Started GAudioH – GiPodH Symptom iPod cannot be played. Cause •The input source assigned to •Switch to the input source “iPod dock” is not selected. assigned at “iPod dock”. •Cable is not properly connected. •Reconnect. •Control Dock for iPod’s AC •Plug the Control Dock for iPod’s adapter is not connected to AC adapter into a power outlet. power outlet. 35 14 – 71 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 75 2007/09/28 11:42:03 ENGLISH Getting Started Specifications Connections Setup Playback Remote Control Multi-Zone Information Troubleshooting nAudio section nVideo section • Power amplifier Front (A, B): Rated output: 110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) Center: 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) Surround : 110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) Surround Back: 110 W + 110 W (8 Ω/ohms, 20 Hz ~ 20 kHz with 0.05 % T.H.D.) 140 W + 140 W (6 Ω/ohms, 1 kHz with 0.7 % T.H.D.) 120 W x 2ch (8 Ω/ohms) Dynamic power: 170 W x 2ch (4 Ω/ohms) Output terminals: Front: A or B 6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms A + B 8 ~ 16 Ω/ohms Center, Surround, Surr. Back: 6 ~ 16 Ω/ohms • Analog Input sensitivity / Input impedance: 200 mV / 47 kΩ/kohms 10 Hz ~ 100 kHz +1, -3 dB (DIRECT mode) Frequency response: 102 dB (DIRECT mode) S/N: 0.005 % (20 Hz ~ 20 kHz) (DIRECT mode) Distortion: 1.2 V Rated output: • Digital Rated output — 2 V (at 0 dB playback) D/A output: Total harmonic distortion — 0.008 % (1 kHz, at 0 dB) S /N ratio — 102 dB Dynamic range — 96 dB Format — Digital audio interface Digital input: • Phono equalizer (PHONO input — REC OUT) 2.5 mV Input sensitivity: ±1 dB (20 Hz to 20 kHz) RIAA deviation: 74 dB (A weighting, with 5 mV input) S/N: 150 mV Rated output: 0.03 % (1 kHz, 3 V) Distortion factor: • Standard video connectors Input / output level and impedance: Frequency response: • S-Video connectors Input / output level and impedance: Frequency response: • Color component video connector Input / output level and impedance: Frequency response: nTuner section Receiving Range: Usable Sensitivity: 50 dB Quieting Sensitivity: S/N (IHF-A): Total harmonic Distortion (at 1 kHz): 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms 5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”) Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms C (color) signal — 0.3 (PAL) / 0.286 (NTSC) Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms 5 Hz ~ 10 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”) Y (brightness) signal — 1 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms PB / CB signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms PR / CR signal — 0.7 Vp-p, 75 Ω/ohms 5 Hz ~ 100 MHz — +0, –3 dB (when video convert set to “OFF”) [FM] (note: µV at 75 Ω/ohms, 0 dBf = 1 x 10-15 W) 87.5 MHz ~ 108.0 MHz 1.0 µV (11.2 dBf) MONO 1.6 µV (15.3 dBf) STEREO 23 µV (38.5 dBf) MONO 77 dB STEREO 72 dB MONO 0.15 % STEREO 0.3 % [AM] 522 kHz ~ 1611 kHz 18 µV nGeneral Power supply: Power consumption: Maximum external dimensions: Weight: AC 230 V, 50 Hz 500 W 0.3 W (Standby) 434 (W) x 171 (H) x 420 (D) mm 13.1 kg nMain remote control unit (RC-1068) Batteries: Maximum external dimensions: Weight: LR6/AA Type (two batteries) 63 (W) x 238 (H) x 31 (D) mm 190 g (including batteries) nSub remote control unit (RC-1071) Batteries: Maximum external dimensions: Weight: R03/AAA Type (two batteries) 54 (W) x 115 (H) x 23 (D) mm 80 g (including batteries) z For purposes of improvement, specifications and design are subject to change without notice. 72 1.AVR2808E2_ENG.indd 76 2007/09/28 11:42:04 List of preset codes / Liste von voreingestellten Codes / Liste de codes préréglés / Lista dei codici pre-regolati / Lista de códigos pre-ajustados / Lijst van vooringestelde codes / Förteckning över förinställda koder Denon Amp D Denon 81001, 82001, 83001, 84001 Denon Tuner D H Denon (Analog) 52863, 52795, 52800, 52805 Denon iPod D Denon 72815, 72816, 72817, 72818 Cable A B C D E F G A-Mark ABC Accuphase Acorn Action Active ADB Aichi Denshi Americast Amstrad Archer Auna Austar BCC Bell South Bestlink Birmingham Cable Communications British Telecom Cable & Wireless Century Coship Daehan Daeryung Digeo Director DX Antenna Emerson Encon Fosgate Foxtel France Telecom Freebox Fujitsu Galaxi GE Gehua 00008, 00144 00237, 00003, 00008 00003 00237 00237 00237 01230 01512 00899 01222 00237 01230 00276 00276 00899 00303 00276 00003 01068 00008 01462 00778 01877, 00877, 00477, 00008 01187 00476 01500 00303 00008 00276 01222 00817 01482 01497 00008 00237, 00144 00476 I J K L M General Instrument Gibralter GNI GoldStar Hitachi Hongtian Jiangsu Hwalin Insight Jerrold Jiuzhou KNC LG Macab Madritel Maspro Matav Memorex Mitsubishi Motorola N O P MS NEC Noos Nova Vision Novaplex NTL Oak Ono Optus Pace Panasonic Paragon Penney Philips Pioneer Q R S Pulsar PVP Stereo Visual Matrix Quasar RadioShack Regal Runco Sagem Salora Samsung Scientific Atlanta Skyworth Sony Sprucer 00476, 00810, 00276, 00003 00003 01466 00144 00003, 00008 01462 00303 00476, 00810 00476, 00810, 00276, 00003 01445 00008 00144 00817 01230 01510 01082 00000 00003 01376, 00476, 00810, 00276, 01187 00303 01496 00817 00008 00008 00276, 00003, 01060, 01068 00303 01068 00276, 01060 01877, 00877, 00237, 00008, 01060, 01068, 01577 00000, 00008, 00144, 01488 00000, 00008, 00525 00000 01305, 00317, 00817 01877, 00877, 00144, 00533, 01500 00000 00003 00000 00303 00276 00000 00817 00000 00003, 00000, 00144, 00778, 00840, 01060, 01666 01877, 00877, 00477, 00237, 00003, 00000, 00008, 01510 01464 01006, 01460 00144 T U V Z Starcom StarHub Sumitomo Supercable Taihan TCL Telewest Time Warner cable TongKook Torx Toshiba Trans PX TS United Cable US Electronics Videoway Visiopass Zenith 00003 00276 01500, 01504 00276 00778 01445 01068 01877 00840 00003 00000, 01509 00276, 00303 00003, 00303 00276, 00003 00276, 00003, 00008 00000 00817 00000, 00525, 00899 California Audio Labs Cambridge Cambridge Audio Cambridge Soundworks Carver CDC CEC Copland Curtis Mathes Cyrus D F G Cable/PVR Combination b1 A D F G J M P S T Z Americast Digeo Freebox General Instrument Jerrold Motorola Pace Pioneer Scientific Atlanta Sony Supercable Time Warner cable Zenith 00899 01187 01482 00810 00810 01376, 00810, 01187 01877, 00237 01877, 00877 01877, 00877 01006 00276 01877 00899 H I J K L CD Player A B C Acoustic Research Advantage Aiwa Arcam Audio Research Audiolab Audiomeca Audioton AVI Balanced Audio Technology Burmester Bush Cairn 40420 40032 40157 40157 40157 40157 40157 40157 40157 40157 40420 40388 40157 M Denon DKK DMX Electronics Dual Dynaco Dynamic Bass Fisher Garrard Genexxa Goldmund Grundig Hafler Harman/Kardon Hitachi Inkel Integra Jerrold JVC Kenwood KLH Krell Linn Loewe Luxman LXI Magnavox Marantz Matsui MCS Memorex Meridian Micromega Miro Mission Modulaire MTC Musical Fidelity 40029, 40303 40157 40157 40157 40157, 40179 40420 40420 40393 40032 40157 40873, 40003, 40766, [42867]z, 42868 40000 40157 40003 40157 40179 40000, 40179 40393, 40420 40000, 40032, 40037, 40179 40157 40157 40173 40100, 40157, 40173 40032 40157 40101 40003 40032, 40072 40681, 40000, 40029, 40157, 40028, 40037, 40036, 40190 41318 40157 40157 40157 40393 40179 40157 40029, 40157 40157 40029 40000, 40032, 40179, 40420, 40468 40157 40157 40000 40157 40000, 40032, 40087, 40179, 40420, 40468 40420 40393 N O Myryad NAD Naim NSM Onkyo Optimus P Q R Orion Panasonic Parasound Penney Philips Pioneer Polk Audio Proceed Proton QED Quad Quasar Radiola RadioShack RCA Realistic S Restek Revox Roksan Rotel Royal SAE Saisho Sansui Sanyo SAST Sears Sharp Siemens Silsonic Simaudio Sonic Frontiers Sony T Sugden Sylvania TAG McLaren Tandy Tascam Teac Technics Techwood 40157 40000, 40721 40157 40157 40868, 40101 40000, 40032, 40037, 40087, 40179, 40393, 40420, 40468 40393 40029, 40303, 40388, 40752 40420 40029 40157 40032, 40101, 40468 40157 40420 40157 40157 40157 40029 40157 40000, 40032, 40179, 40420, 40468 40032, 40053, 40179, 40420, 40468 40000, 40032, 40087, 40179, 40420, 40468 40157 40157 40420 40157, 40420 40420 40157 40000 40000, 40157 40000, 40087, 40179 40157 40179 40037 40157 40036 40157 40157 40490, 40000, 40100, 41364, 40185 40157 40157 40157 40032 40393, 40420 40490, 40393, 40420 40029, 40303 40303 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 1 2007/09/28 12:59:15 U V W Thomson Thorens Thule Audio Tokai Universum Victor Wadia 40053 40157 40157 40420 40157, 40053 40072 40393 40000, 40032, 40157, 40053, 40087, 40179 40490, 40868, 40032, 40036 40000 Wards Y Yamaha Yorx CD Recorder D J R S T Denon JVC RCA Sony Teac Thomson 40766, 42868 40072 40053, 40420 40000, 40100, 41364 40420 40053 C D F G H I J K L M O P Aiwa Akai Arcam Audiolab Carver 20029, 20197, 20200, 21315 20283, 20439 20076 20029 20029 20076, 20371, 21311, [22471]z 20074 20308, 20309, 20375, 20439 20439 20375 20029, 20375 20182, 20029, 21314 20070, 20071, 20337 20244, 20273, 20274, 20303, 20304, 20310, 21309 20070, 20071, 20092, 20233, 20234, 21364 20375 20308, 20309 20029 20029, 20009 20099 20283, 20439 20029 20135, 20136, 20282 20027, 20220, 20337, 20439 20308, 20309 20375 20229 20029, 20229 Denon Fisher Garrard Genexxa GoldStar Grundig Harman/Kardon Inkel JVC Kenwood LG Luxman Magnavox Marantz Memorex Mitsubishi Myryad Onkyo Optimus Orion Palladium Panasonic Philips Pioneer R S Polk Audio Radiola RCA Revox Sansui Sanyo Sharp Sherwood Sonic Sony Tape Deck A Phonotrend T TaeKwang Tandberg Teac U V W Y Technics Technovox Thorens Universum Victor Wards Wharfedale Yamaha 20337 20027, 20220, 20099, 20109, 21306, 21312 20029 20029 20027, 20220 20029 20029, 20009 20074 20231, 20371 20337 20375 20243, 20170, 20291, 20234, 21313 20439 20109 20280, 20283, 20289, 20308, 20309 20229 20229 20029 20375, 20439 20244, 20273, 20274 20027, 20029 20439 20097, 20094 HDTV Tuner b1 A C D E G H I L M N P ABS Accurian Alienware CyberPower D-Link Dgtec Epson Gateway Hewlett Packard Howard Computers HP Hush iBUYPOWER LG Linksys Media Center PC Microsoft Mind Motorola Niveus Media Northgate Packard Bell Panasonic Pioneer 01272 01653 01272 01272 01554 01363 01563 01272 01272, 01267 01272 01272, 01267 01272 01272 01415 01272, 01365 01272 01272, 01805 01272 01363 01272 01272 01272 01120 01010 R S T V X Z Ricavision Samsung Sensory Science Sharp SMC Sony Stack 9 Sylvania Systemax Tagar Systems Toshiba Touch Viewsonic Vizio Voodoo Xbox ZT Group 01272 01190, 01490 01126 01010 01456 01272, 01324, 01364 01272 01563 01272 01272 01272 01272 01272, 01329 01126 01272 01805 01272 Astro Atlantic Telephone Atsat AtSky Audioline Aurora Austar B Satellite Receiver A @sat @Sky A-Mark ABsat ADB AGS Aiwa Akai Alba Allsat Alltech Allvision AlphaStar Amitronica Amstrad Anglo Ankaro AntSat Apollo Arcon Armstrong Arnion Asat ASCI ASLF AssCom Astacom Aston Astra Astratec 01300 01334 00345 00123, 00713 00642, 01259, 01367, 01418, 01473, 01491 00710 01514 00200 00455, 00713, 01284, 01659, 01811 00200, 01043 00713 01232, 01334, 01412 00772 00713 00345, 00713, 00795, 00847, 00863, 00882, 01113, 01175, 01693, 01801 00713 00713 01083 00455 01043, 01075 00200 01300 00200 01334 00713 00853 00710 00142 00713 01743 Axiel Axil Axis B@ytronic Beko Bell ExpressVu Big Sat Black Diamond Blaupunkt Blue Sky Boca Boston Brainwave British Sky Broadcasting Broco BskyB BT Bubu Sat Bush C Canal Canal Digital Canal Satellite Canal+ Centrex CGV Chaparral Cherokee Chess Chili CityCom Classic Clatronic CNS Comag Condor Conia Contec Continental Edison Coship Crossdigital Crown Cryptovision 00173, 00658, 01099, 01100, 01113 01333 01300 01334 01672 00642, 00879, 01333, 01433 00497, 00642, 00863, 00879, 01176, 01259 00710 01457, 01659 01111 01412 00455 00775 01457 01284 00173 00713 00713, 01232, 01366 00710, 01251 00658, 01672 D 00847, 01175, 01662, 01847 00713 00847, 01175, 01662 00710, 01296 00713 01284, 01645, 01672, 01743, 01811 00853 00853, 01622 00853, 01339, 01853 00853 01457 01413, 01567 00216 00123, 00710 00713, 01085, 01334, 01626 01718 00299, 00394, 00818, 01075, 01176, 01232 01672 01413 01367 01232, 01366, 01412, 01413 01700 01695 00394 01695 01457 01109 01284 00455, 00795 E Cyfra+ Cyrus D-box Daewoo Delfa Deltasat Dgtec Digenius Digiality Digifusion DigiLogic DigiQuest DigiSat Digisky DigitAll World Digiturk Digiwave Dijam DiPro 01076 00200 00723, 00873, 01114 00713, 01111, 01296, 01743 00863 01075 01542, 01631, 01242 00299 01685 01645, 01743 01284 00863, 01300, 01457, 01473 01232 01457 01227 01076 01631 01296 01367, 01543 01377, 00392, 00566, 00639, 01639, 01142, 00247, 00749, 01749, 00724, 00819, 01856, DirecTV 01076, 01108, 00099, 01109, 01414, 01442, 01609, 01392, 01640 Discovery 00710 Dish Network System 01505, 01005, 00775, 01775 Dishpro 01505, 01005, 00775, 01775 Distratel 01283, 01704 DMT 01075 DNT 00200 Dream Multimedia 01237 DSE 01375 DSTV 00642, 00879, 01433 Durabrand 01284 DX Antenna 01530 01505, 01005, 00775, 00455, 00610, 00713, 00853, 00871, Echostar 01086, 01200, 01323, 01409, 01418, 01473, 01775 Einhell 00713 Elap 00713, 01567 Elsat 00713 Elta 00200, 01659 Emme Esse 00871 Energy Sistem 01631 Engel 00713, 01251 EP Sat 00455 Esat 00879 Eurieult 00882 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 2 2007/09/28 12:59:16 F G H Eurocrypt EuroLine Europa Europhon Eurosky Eurostar Eutelsat Expressvu Fenner Ferguson Finlandia Finlux Flair Mate FMD Force Fortec Star 00455 01251 00863 00299 00262, 00299 00818 00713 00775, 01775 00713 00455, 01291, 01743 00455 00455 00713 01251, 01413, 01457 01101 01083 00455, 00497, 00795, 00879, Foxtel 01162, 01176, 01356 Fracapro Planet 00871 Fracarro 00125, 00871 France Telecom 00871 Freesat 00882 FTE 00863 FTEmaximal 00713, 00863 00173, 00262, 00299, 00394, Fuba 01214, 01251, 01801 Fugionkyo 00125 Funai 01377 00853, 00863, 01101, 01111, Galaxis 01557 Gardiner 00818 Garnet 01075 GbSAT 01214 GE 00392, 00566 Gecco 01412 General Instrument 00869 General Satellite 01176 GF Good Friends 01043 GF Star 01043 01251, 01334, 01412, 01429, Globo 01626 GOD Digital 00200 GOI 00775, 01775 Gold Box 00853 Gold Vision 01631 Golden Interstar 01283 GoldStar 00394 Goodmans 00455, 01284, 01291 Gradiente 00887 Granada 00455 00173, 00345, 00847, 00853, Grundig 00879, 01291 Handan 01622 Hanseatic 01099, 01100 Hauppauge HB HDT Hills Hirschmann Hisense Hitachi Homecast Hornet Houston HTS Hughes Network Systems Humax I J K Huth Hyundai iCan ID Digital ILLUSION sat iLo Imperial Indovision Ingelen Innova Interstar InVideo ISkyB Italtel ITT Nokia Jadeworld Jaeger Jerrold Jiuzhou JOK JVC K-SAT Kamm Kaon KaTelco Kathrein Kennex Kenwood Klap Kocmoc TB Koscom Kosmos Kreiling 01672 01214, 01801 01159 01232 00125, 00173, 00299, 00710, 00882, 01085, 01111, 01232, 01412 01535 00749, 00819, 00455, 01250, 01284, 01518, 01523, 01525 01214, 01680, 01700 01300 00775 00775, 01775 L 01142, 00749, 01749, 01442 00863, 01176, 01225, 01406, 01427, 01675, 01743, 01790, 01915 01075 01075, 01159 01367 01176 01557, 01631 01535 01334, 01429, 01672 00887 00882 00099 01214 00871 00887 00871 00455, 00723, 00873 00642 01334 00869 01450 00710 00775, 01507, 01531, 01775 00713 00713 01300 01111 00123, 00173, 00200, 00249, 00394, 00442, 00480, 00504, 00658, 00713, 00818, 01221, 01416, 01561, 01567 00125 00853 00710 01333 01043 00442, 01333 00249, 00658 M Kreiselmeyer Kross L&S Electronic Labgear LaSAT Lava Legend Legrand Lemon Lenco Lenoxx LG Lifesat Lodos Logik Logix Lorenzen Luxor M Electronic M vision Magnavox Manata Manhattan Marantz Maspro Master’s Matsui Maximum McIntosh MDS Mediabox Mediacom MediaSa Medion Medison Mega Memorex Metronic Metz MiCO Micro Micro Elektronic Micro Technology Micromaxx Microstar Microtec Mitsubishi Morgan’s Motorola MTEC Muller 00173 01695 01043, 01334 01296 00173, 00299 01631 01718 01718 01334 00713 01611 01075, 01414 00299, 00713, 01043 01284 01284 01075 00299 00345, 00873 00818 01557 00724, 00722 00710, 00713 00455, 00710, 01083 00200 00173, 00713, 01530 00394 00173, 00710, 01284, 01743 01075, 01334, 01685 00869 01225 00853 01206 00853 00299, 00713, 01043, 01075, 01232, 01334, 01412, 01626 00713 00200 00724 00713, 00818, 01283, 01334, 01375, 01704 00173 01811 00713 00713 00713 00299 01075 00713 00749, 00455 00200, 00713, 01232, 01412 00869, 00856, 01473 01214 01695 Multibroadcast Multichoice N Mx Onda Myryad Mysat MySky NEC NEOTION Netgem Netsat Neuf TV Neuhaus Neuling Neusat Nevir Next Level Nikko Noda Electronic Nokia O Nordmende OctalTV Okano Omega Opentel Optex P Optimus Optus Orbis Orbitech Origo OSAT P/Sat Pace Pacific Packard Bell Packsat Palcom Panarex Panasat Panasonic Panda Pansat Patriot Paysat peeKTon 00642, 00879 00642, 00879, 01333, 01433, 01559, 01560 01659 00200 00713 01693, 01848, 01850 01519 01334 01322 00099, 00887 01322 00713 01232 00713 01659 00869 00200, 00713, 00723 01704 00455, 00723, 00751, 00853, 00873, 01023, 01223, 01723 00455, 01611 01505 00442 00887 01232, 01412 00394, 00713, 01043, 01283, 01611 00724 00879 01232, 01334, 01412 01099, 01100 00497 00345 01232 00200, 00329, 00455, 00497, 00795, 00847, 00853, 00887, 01175, 01323, 01356, 01423, 01693, 01717, 01848, 01850 01284, 01375 01111 00710 00299, 01409 01159 00615, 00879, 01333, 01433 00247, 00701, 00455, 00847, 01304, 01404, 01508, 01526, 01527 00173, 00455 01159 00710 00724 01457 Philips Phonotrend Pilotime Pino Pioneer Q R Planet Plasmatic PMB Polytron Portland Preisner Premier Prima Primacom Primestar Profile Promax Proscan Proton QNS Quadral Quelle Radiola RadioShack Radix RCA S Rebox Regal RFT Roadstar Rollmaster Rover Rownsonic SAB Saba Sabre Sagem Samsung Sat Control Sat Team SAT+ Satec Satelco Satplus 01142, 00749, 01749, 00775, 00724, 00819, 01076, 00722, 00099, 00710, 00455, 00818, 00200, 00847, 00853, 00173, 01114, 00133, 01442, 01543, 01672 00863, 01200 01339 01334 01142, 00329, 00853, 01308, 01442 00871 00442 00713, 01611 00394 01296 00262, 01101, 01113, 01366 00723, 00853, 00873, 01429 00795 01111 00869 00710 00455 00392, 00566 01535 01367, 01402, 01404 00710 00299 00200 00566, 00775, 00869 00394, 00882, 01113, 01317 00392, 00566, 01142, 00775, 00855, 00143, 01291, 01392, 01442 01214 01251 00200 00713, 00853 01413 00713 01567 01251 00710, 00820 00455 00820, 01114, 01253, 01307, 01690 01377, 01142, 01276, 01108, 01109, 00853, 00863, 01206, 01442, 01458, 01570, 01609, 01700, 01916 01300 00713 01409 00713 01232 01100 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 3 2007/09/28 12:59:17 Satstation Schaub Lorenz Schneider 01083 01214 00710, 01206, 01251 00394, 00504, 00863, 01075, Schwaiger 01083, 01111, 01317, 01334, 01412, 01457 SCS 00299 Sedea Electronique 00125, 01206, 01283, 01626 SEG 01075, 01087, 01251, 01626 Seleco 00871 Septimo 01375 Serd 01412 Serino 00610 Servimat 01611 ServiSat 00713, 01251 Sharp 01517 Siemens 00173, 01334, 01429 Silva 00299 Skantin 00713 SKR 00713 00856, 00099, 00847, 00887, SKY 01014, 01175, 01662, 01693, 01847, 01848, 01850 SKY Italia 00853, 01693, 01847, 01848 Sky Television 01014 Sky XL 01251, 01412 Sky+ 01175 00713, 01075, 01085, 01200, Skymaster 01334, 01409, 01567, 01611 Skymax 00200 Skyplus 01232, 01334, 01412 SkySat 00713 Skyvision 01334 SL 00299, 01672 SM Electronic 00713, 01200, 01409 00713, 00882, 01101, 01113, Smart 01232, 01404, 01413 00639, 01639, 00455, 00847, Sony 00853, 01524, 01558, 01640 Star 00887 Star Choice 00869 Star Trak 00772, 00869 Starland 00713 Starlite 00200 Stream 01847, 01848 00125, 00713, 00820, 00853, Strong 00879, 01159, 01284, 01300, 01409, 01626 Sunkai 00123 Sunny 01300 Sunsat 00713 Sunstar 00642 Supernova 00887 SVA 01455 Systec 01334 T Tantec Tarbs Tatung TBoston Teac Tecatel TechniSat Technomate Technosonic Technotrend Techwood Tele System Electronic Teleciel TeleClub Telefunken Teleka Telestar Telesystem Televes Televisa Telewire Tevion Thomson Thorn Tiny Tioko Tivo Tokai Tonna Topfield Toshiba TPS Triax U Trio TT-micro Turnsat Twinner UEC UltimateTV Uniden Unisat United Universum US Digital USDTV 00455 01225 00455 01659 01225, 01227, 01251, 01322 01200 00262, 00455, 00863, 01099, 01100, 01195, 01197, 01322 01283, 01610 01672 01429 01284, 01626 V Visiosat 01251, 01409, 01611, 01801 01043 01367 00710 00262, 00442 01099, 01100, 01251, 01334, 01610, 01626 01801 00455, 01214, 01300, 01334 00887 01232 00713, 01409, 01622, 01672 00392, 00566, 00455, 00710, 00713, 00820, 00847, 00853, 01046, 01175, 01291, 01534, 01543, 01662 00455 01672 00394 01142, 01442 00200 00455, 00713, 01611 01206, 01208, 01545, 01783 00749, 01749, 00790, 00819, 00455, 01285, 01501, 01516, 01530 00820, 01253, 01307 00200, 00713, 00853, 01113, 01227, 01251, 01291, 01296, 01626 01075 01429 00713 00713, 01611 00879, 01162, 01333, 01356 01392, 01640 00724, 00722 00200 01251 00173, 00299, 01087, 01099, 01251 01535 01535 Variosat Ventana Vestel VH Sat Viasat ViewSat Visionic VisionNet W Viva Vivid Voom VTech Wavelength Wewa Wharfedale Winbox Wintel Wisi Worldsat X Xcom XMS Xsat Y Z Xtreme Yakumo Yamada Yes Zehnder Zenith Zeta Technology Zodiac 00173 00200 01251 00299 01682 01232 00125, 01283 01557 00142, 00710, 00713, 01413, 01457, 01718 00856 01162 00869 00818 01232, 01413 00455 01284 01801 00299 00173, 00299, 00455 00123, 00710, 01214, 01251, 01543 00123 01075 00123, 00713, 00847, 01214, 01323 01300 01413 01718 00887 00394, 00504, 00818, 01075, 01232, 01251, 01334, 01412, 01413 00856, 01856 00200 01801 Satellite Receiver/ PVR Combination b1, b3 E F G H K L M N O P b1 A B C D @sat Allvision Amstrad Atsat B@ytronic British Sky Broadcasting BskyB Bush Canal Satellite Comag Digifusion DigiQuest Digiturk 01300 01412 01175 01300 01412 R 01175 S 01175, 01662 01645 01339 01412 01645 01300 01076 01377, 00392, 00639, 01142, 01076, 00099, 01392, 01442, 01640 Dish Network System 01505, 00775 Dishpro 01505, 00775 DMT 01075 Dream Multimedia 01237 Echostar 01505, 00775, 00610 Expressvu 00775 Foxtel 01356 GbSAT 01214 Gecco 01412 Globo 01412 HDT 01159 Hirschmann 01412 Homecast 01680 Hughes Network 01142, 01442 Systems Humax 01176, 01427, 01675 Huth 01075 Hyundai 01075, 01159 Kaon 01300 Kathrein 00249, 00658, 01221, 01561 LG 01075 Maximum 01334 Mediacom 01206 Medion 01412 Microstar 01075 Morgan’s 01412 Motorola 00869 MTEC 01214 Multichoice 01333, 01559, 01560 MySky 01693, 01848, 01850 NEOTION 01334 Nokia 01023 Opentel 01412 Orbis 01412 Pace 01175, 01356, 01423, 01850 Panasonic 01304 Philips 01142, 00099, 01442 Pilotime 01339 Proscan 00392 Radix 01317 RCA 01392 Rebox 01214 Sagem 01253, 01307 Samsung 01206, 01442, 01570, 01609 Sat Control 01300 Schneider 01206 Schwaiger 01075, 01412 Sedea Electronique 01206 Serd 01412 SKY 01175, 01693, 01848, 01850 DirecTV T X Z SKY Italia Sky XL Skymaster Skyplus Sony Star Choice Strong Sunny TechniSat Thomson Topfield TPS Xtreme Zehnder 01848 01412 01075 01412 00639, 01640 00869 01300 01300 01195, 01197 01175, 01534, 01662 01206, 01545, 01783 01253, 01307 01300 01075, 01412 Hughes Network Systems Philips Samsung 20739 b3 H P S 20739 20739 Television 1 A 888 A-Mark A.R. Systems Accent Accuscan Accuscreen Acoustic Research Action Acura Addison ADL Admiral Advent Adventuri Adyson AEG Agashi Agna Aiko Aim Aiwa Akai 10264 10047, 10054, 10009 10037, 10352, 10374, 10455, 10556 10009, 10037 10047 10001 11269 10030, 10650 10009 10092, 10108, 10653 11217 10047, 10054, 10017, 10051, 10093, 10463, 10180, 10163, 10264, 10418 10761, 10783, 10815, 10817, 10842, 10876, 11933 10000 10217 11163, 11556 10217, 10264 10150 10092, 10009, 10035, 10037, 10217, 10264, 10361, 10371, 10433 10706, 10037, 10455, 10805 10264, 10701, 11904, 11911 10000, 10060, 10812, 10702, 10178, 10030, 10145, 10602, 10606, 10631, 10648, 10672, 10714, 10715, 11207, 11537, 11675, 11676, 11903, 10556, 10548, 10480, 10433, 10371, 10361, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10208, 10163, 10037, 10035, 10009 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 4 2007/09/28 12:59:19 Akashi Akiba Akira Akito 10009, 10860 10037, 10218, 10455 10418 10037 10171, 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264, 10668, 10714, 11037, 11498, 11556, 11982 10170 10009, 10036, 10037, 10073, 10163, 10218, 10352, 10370, 10371, 10418, 10443, 10487, 10668, 10714, 11037 10700, 10843 10672 10865, 11269 10030, 10170 10217 10037 10150 10180 10000, 10060 10217, 10370 10000, 10171, 10009, 10011, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264, 10362, 10371, 10433, 10648, 11037, 11982 10000, 10180 10250, 10180, 10009, 10037, 10700, 10861 10250, 10037, 10650 11149, 11163 10009, 10264 10051 10009, 10037, 10264 10009, 10037, 10163, 10370, 10374, 10668 10451, 10093, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10009, 10108 10264 10156, 10748, 10879, 10765, 10767, 11217, 11943 10352, 10556 10109 10217 10037, 10714 10163 10037, 10556 11037 10163 10070 10037 10009 10037 10217, 10218, 10264 10698 10001, 10037 Akura Alaron Alba Albatron Alfide All-Tel Alleron Allorgan Allstar Ambassador America Action American High Amplivision Amstrad Amtron Anam Anam National Andersson Anglo Anhua Anitech Ansonic AOC Aolinpike Apex Digital AR Arc En Ciel Arcam Ardem Aristocrat Aristona ART Arthur Martin ASA Asberg Asora Astra Asuka ATD Atlantic Atori Auchan Audinac Audiosonic Audioton Audiovox Audioworld Aumark Autovox Aventura AVP Awa B Axion Axxent Baier Baihe Baile Baird Bang & Olufsen Baohuashi Baosheng Barco Basic Line Bastide Bauer Baur Baysonic Bazin Beaumark Beijing Beko Belcor Bell & Howell Belson Belstar BenQ Beon Berthen Best Bestar Bestar-Daewoo Binatone Black Diamond 10009 10163 10180 10009, 10037, 10109, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10370, 10374, 10486, 10714, 10715, 10820 10217, 10264, 10370, 10486 10451, 10180, 10092, 10623, 10802, 10875, 11937, 11951, 11952 10698 10060 10217 10171 10000 10451, 10009, 10011, 10036, 10108, 10217, 10264, 10374, 10606 11937, 11958 10009 10876 10009, 10264 10001, 10009, 10374, 10661 10037, 10073, 10109, 10208, 10217, 10343, 11196 10565 10264 10009, 10817 10163, 10556 10009, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10218, 10374, 10455, 10556, 10668, 11037, 11163 10217 10805 10037, 10195, 10361, 10455, 10512 10180 10217 10017, 10178, 10030 10812, 10001, 10009, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817, 10821 10037, 10195, 10370, 10418, 10486, 10606, 10714, 10715, 10808, 11037 10030 10054, 10017, 10154, 10093 10698, 11191 11037 11032, 11756 10037, 10163, 10218, 10418 10668 10370 10037, 10370, 10374 10374 10217 10614, 10820, 10821, 11037, 11163, 11909 Blackway Blaupunkt Blue Sky Boots BPL Bradford Brandt Brinkmann Brionvega Britannia Brockwood Broksonic Brother BSR BTC Bush C Caihong Cailing Candle Canton Capehart Capetronic Capsonic Carad Carena Carnivale Carrefour Carver Cascade Casio Cathay CCE Celebrity Celera Celestial Centrex Centrum Centurion CGE Changcheng Changfei Changfeng Changhai 10218 10036, 10170, 10195, 10200, 10327, 10455 10037, 10218, 10455, 10487, 10499, 10556, 10668, 10714, 10715, 11037, 11191, 11363 10009, 10217 10037, 10208 10180 10109, 10287, 10335, 10560, 10625, 10714 10037, 10418, 10486, 10668 10037, 10362 10217 10178, 10030 10236, 10463, 10180, 11911, 11938 10264 10163 10218 11900, 11556, 11037, 10778, 10714, 10698, 10668, 10661, 10614, 10556, 10487, 10374, 10371, 10361, 10335, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10208, 10163, 10037, 10036, 10009 10009, 10817 10748 10030 10218 10017, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10036 10030 10264 10610, 10668, 11037 10037, 10455 10030 10036, 10037, 10070 10054, 10170 10009, 10037 10037 10037, 10218 10037, 10217 10000 10765 10767, 10819, 10820, 10821 10780 11037 10037 10074, 10163, 10370, 10418 10051, 10001, 10009, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817 10009, 10374, 10817 10264, 10817 10009, 10817 10156, 10765, 10009, 10264, 10508, 10767, 10783, 10817, 10819, 10820, 10821, 11008, 11156 Chengdu 10009, 10817 Ching Tai 10092, 10009 10000, 10180, 10092, 10009, Chun Yun 10700, 10843 Chunfeng 10009, 10264 Chung Hsin 10180, 10053, 10036, 10108 Chunsun 10009, 10817 Cimline 10009, 10218 Cinema 10672 Cineral 10451, 10092 Cinex 10648, 11556 Citek 10047 10054, 10000, 10451, 10463, Citizen 10180, 10060, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10001, 10035 City 10009 Clarion 10180 Clarivox 10037, 10070, 10418 Classic 10030, 10092, 10499 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, Clatronic 10264, 10370, 10371, 10714 Clayton 11037 CMS Hightec 10217 10047, 10054, 10017, 10060, Colortyme 10178, 10030 Commercial Solutions 11447, 10047 Concorde 10009 10009, 10037, 10264, 10370, Condor 10418 Conia 10820, 10821, 11498 Conic 10178 Conrac 10808 10156, 10145, 10009, 10264, Conrowa 10698, 11156, 11170 Contec 10180, 10009, 10036, 10037 Continental Edison 10109, 10287, 10487 Cosmel 10009, 10037 Craig 10180, 10171 10054, 10000, 10180, 10030, Crosley 10171, 10074, 10163, 10370 10093, 10180, 10053, 10009, 10037, 10208, 10370, 10418, Crown 10486, 10487, 10606, 10672, 10712, 10714, 10715, 11037 Crown Mustang 10672 CS Electronics 10218 CTX 11756 10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10051, 10451, 10093, 10180, Curtis Mathes 10060, 10702, 10178, 10030, 10145, 10166, 10037, 10035, 11147, 11347 CXC 10180 Cybertron 10218 Cytronix 11298 D-Vision 10037, 10556, 11982 Changhong D Daewoo Dainichi Dansai Dantax Datsura Dawa Daytek Dayton Daytron Dayu De Graaf Decca Degraff Deitron Dell Denko Denon Denver Desmet Diamant Diamond Digatron Digiline Digital Life Digitex Digitor Digix Media Dixi DL Domeos Domland Dongda Donghai Dream Vision DSE DTS Dual Dual Tec Dumont Durabrand Dux Dwin Dynatech Dynatron 10154, 10451, 10180, 10178, 10030, 10092, 11661, 10634, 10661, 10672, 10700, 10860, 10865, 10876, 10880, 11755, 11756, 11909, 10623, 10556, 10499, 10374, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10170, 10109, 10108, 10037, 10036, 10009 10218 10009, 10035, 10036, 10037, 10208, 10217 10370, 10486, 10714, 10715 10208 10009, 10037 10672, 11207 10092, 10009, 11207 10180, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10009, 10036, 10037, 10374 10374, 10661 10163, 10208, 10548 10037, 10217 10163, 10208 10374 11080, 11178 10264 10145, 10511 10037, 10587 10009, 10037 10037 10706, 10009, 10371, 10672, 10698, 10820, 10860 10037 10037, 10668 10872 10820 10037 10880 10009, 10037, 10217 10587, 10780, 10872 10668 10394 10009 10009 11164, 11704 10698, 10820, 11556 10009 10037, 10217, 10343, 10352, 10394, 11037, 11137 10217 10017, 10180, 10178, 10070, 10217 10463, 10180, 10178, 10171, 11034, 11463 10037 10093 10217 10037 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 5 2007/09/28 12:59:20 E F Easy Living Eaton Ecco ECE Edison-Minerva 11248 10060 10773 10037 10487 10037, 10217, 10218, 10362, Elbe 10610 Elcit 10163 Electroband 10000 Electrograph 11755 10154, 10000, 10463, 10150, Electrohome 10178, 10030, 10073 Elekta 10009, 10264 Elfunk 11037, 11208 ELG 10037 Elin 10009, 10037, 10361, 10548 Elite 10037, 10218 Elta 10009, 10264 Emerald 10178 10047, 10017, 10154, 10451, 10236, 10463, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10171, 11944, 11911, Emerson 11909, 10714, 10668, 10623, 10486, 10036, 10371, 10370, 10361, 10037, 10195, 10170, 10070, 10073 Envision 10030, 10813 Enzer 10860 Erae 11371 Erres 10037 ESA 10812, 10171, 11944 ESC 10037, 10217 Ether 10030, 10009 Etron 10001, 10009, 10163, 10820 Eurofeel 10217, 10264 Euroman 10037, 10217, 10264, 10370 Europa 10037 Europhon 10037, 10109, 10217 Evesham Technology 11248 Evolution 11756 Expert 10163 Exquisit 10037 Feilang 10009 Feilu 10009, 10817 Feiyan 10264 Feiyue 10009, 10817 Fenner 10009, 10374 Fer0 10335 10053, 10037, 10073, 10109, 10195, 10287, 10335, 10343, Ferguson 10443, 10548, 10560, 10625, 11037 10171, 10037, 10163, 10217, Fidelity 10264, 10361, 10371, 10512 Filsai 10217 10163, 10208, 10346, 10361, Finlandia 10548 Finlux Firstar Firstline Fisher Flint Force Formenti Fortress Fraba Friac Frontech Fujimaro Fujitsu Fujitsu General Fujitsu Siemens Funai G Furi Furichi Futronic Futuretech Galaxi Galaxis Ganxin Gateway GBC GE GEC Geloso Gemini General General Technic Genesis Genexxa Gericom Gevalt Giant Gibralter Go Video Go Vision Goldfunk GoldStar 10037, 10070, 10163, 10217, 10346, 10480, 10556, 10631, 10714, 10715, 10808, 11556 10236, 10009 10009, 10037, 10208, 10217, 10361, 10374, 10556, 10668, 10714, 10808, 11037, 11191, 11363, 11371 10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10036, 10208, 10217, 10361, 10370 10037, 10218, 10264, 10455, 10610 11149 10037, 10163 10093 10037, 10370 10009, 10037, 10370, 10499, 10610 10009, 10163, 10217, 10264 10865, 11498 10009, 10217, 10352, 10683, 10809, 10853 10009, 10217, 10683 10808, 10809, 11163, 11298 10000, 10180, 10171, 10264, 10668, 11271, 11904 10145, 10264, 10817 10860 10264, 10860 10180 10037 10037, 10370 10817 11755, 11756 10009, 10163, 10218, 10374 11447, 10047, 11454, 10000, 10051, 10451, 10093, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10092, 11922, 11917, 11347, 11147, 10625, 10560, 10335, 10035 10037, 10163, 10217, 10361 10009, 10163, 10374 10047 10109, 10287 10009 10009, 10037 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218 10808, 10865, 10880, 11217, 11298 11371 10009, 10217 10017, 10000, 10030 10060, 10886 11937 10668 10047, 10054, 10154, 10178, 10030, 10715, 10714, 10606, 10455, 10361, 10217, 10163, 10109, 10073, 10037, 10036, 10009, 10001 Gooding Goodmans Gorenje GPM Gradiente Graetz Gran Prix Granada Grandin Gronic Grundig H Grundy Grunkel Grunpy H&B Haaz Haier Haihong Haiyan Halifax Hallmark Hampton Hanimex Hankook Hanseatic Hantarex Hantor Harley Davidson Harman/Kardon Harsper Harvard Harwa Harwood Hauppauge Havermy HCM Heathkit Helios Hello Kitty 10487 10000, 11909, 11900, 11163, 11037, 10880, 10808, 10714, 10668, 10661, 10634, 10625, 10587, 10560, 10556, 10499, 10487, 10480, 10374, 10371, 10343, 10335, 10264, 10218, 10217, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10011, 10009 10370 10218 10053, 10037, 10170 10163, 10361, 10371, 10487, 10714, 11163 10648 10036, 10037, 10108, 10163, 10208, 10217, 10226, 10343, 10548, 10560 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10374, 10455, 10610, 10668, 10714, 10715, 10865, 10880, 11037, 11191 10217 10706, 10009, 10036, 10037, 10070, 10163, 10195, 10443, 10487, 10556, 10587, 10672, 10683, 11371 10180, 10195 11163 10180 10808 10706 11034, 10037, 10508, 10587, 10698, 11017 10009 10264, 10817 10217, 10264 10236, 10180, 10178 10217 10218 10180, 10178, 10030 10009, 10037, 10217, 10361, 10370, 10394, 10499, 10556, 10634, 10661, 10714, 10808 10009, 10037, 10865 10037 10000, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 11904 10054 10865 10180 10773, 11196, 11269 10009, 10037, 10487 10037 10093 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10418 10017 10865 10451 Hema Hewlett Packard Hifivox Highline Hikona Hikone Hinari Hisawa Hisense Hitachi Hitachi Fujian Hitec Hitsu Hoeher Home Electronics Hongmei Hongyan Hornyphon Hoshai HP Hua Tun Huafa Huanghaimei Huanghe Huanglong Huangshan Huanyu Huaqiang Huari Hugoson Huodateji Hygashi Hyper Hypersonic Hypson Hyundai I Iberia ICE ICeS Iiyama 10009, 10217 11494, 11502 10109 10037, 10264 10218 10218 10009, 10036, 10037, 10163, 10208, 10218, 10264, 10352, 10443 10218, 10455, 10610, 10714 10156, 10748, 10145, 10009, 10208, 10508, 10556, 10780, 10821, 10860, 11022, 11156, 11170, 11208, 11363 10047, 10054, 10017, 10000, 11256, 10156, 10051, 10150, 10178, 10030, 11145, 10145, 10092, 10744, 10877, 10634, 11037, 11137, 11149, 11156, 11170, 11225, 11576, 11904, 11960, 10578, 10548, 10508, 10499, 10481, 10480, 10343, 10217, 10163, 10109, 10108, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10009 10150, 10108, 10860 10698 10009, 10218, 10455, 10610 10714, 10865, 11163, 11556 10606 10093, 10009, 10264, 10817 10264, 10817 10037 10218, 10455 11494, 11502 10009 10145, 10009 10009 10009, 10817 10009 10009, 10264, 10817 10217, 10264, 10374, 10817 10264 10145, 10264 11217 10051 10217 10009, 10217 10361 10037, 10217, 10264, 10455, 10486, 10556, 10668, 10714, 10715, 11037 10849, 10860, 10865, 10876, 11556 10037 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10371 10218 10877, 11217 Ima Imperial Imperial Crown Indiana Infinity InFocus Ingelen Ingersol Inno Hit Innova Innowert Inotech Insignia Inteq Interbuy Interfunk Internal Intervision Irradio Isukai ITC ITS ITT ITT Nokia J ITV IX JBL JCB JDV Jean JEC Jensen Jiahua JiaLiCai JIL Jinfeng Jinque Jinta Jinxing JMB JNC Jocel Johnson Jubilee Juhua Jutan 10236, 10180, 10178 10037, 10074, 10370, 10418 10001, 10009, 10264, 10374, 10661 10037 10054 11164 10163, 10487, 10610, 10714 10009 10009, 10217, 10218, 11163 10037 10865, 11298 10773, 10820 10171, 11517 10017, 10145 10009, 10037, 10264 10037, 10109, 10163, 10200, 10327, 10361, 10512 10037, 11909 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10394, 10455, 10486, 10487 10009, 10037, 10218, 10371 10037, 10218, 10455 10217 10037, 10218, 10264, 10371 10163, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10610 10070, 10163, 10195, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10606, 10610 10037, 10264, 10374 10877 10054 10000 11982 10156, 10051, 10236, 10092, 10009, 10036 10035 10761, 10815, 10817, 11933 10051 10009, 10264 10030 10051, 10208, 10226, 10817 10009, 10264, 10817 10009, 10264 10054, 10156, 10145, 10009, 10037, 10264, 10556, 10698, 10817, 10821, 11011 10443, 10499, 10556, 10634 10876 10712 10455 10556 10264, 10817 10030 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 6 2007/09/28 12:59:21 10054, 10093, 10463, 10053, 10030, 10070, 10036, 10218, 10371, 10418, 10508, 10606, 10650, 10653, 10683, 10731, 11253, 11923 10009, 10264, 10817 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10455 10217 10017, 10180, 10217 10001, 10009, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817 10009, 10264 10163, 10361 10264, 10370, 10606, 10610, 10714, 10778, 11556 10556 10371 10030 10163 11498 10180, 10060 10037, 10362, 10370, 10610, 10648, 11037 10163 10668, 11037 10180, 10030 10706 10217 10001, 10371, 10455 10706, 10556 10037, 10668 10156, 10180, 10765, 10767, 11962 10037 10030 10037, 10362, 10370, 10374, 10499, 10556, 10610 10180, 10150, 10053, 10036, 10108, 11331 10037, 10218 10009, 10264, 10817 10009 10037 10180, 10037, 10218, 10371, 10418, 10587, 10641, 10714, 10817, 11084 10487 10037 10370 10037 10009 10876 10463, 10180, 10030, 10217 10009, 10264 10009 10051, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10374, 10661, 10817 JVC K Kaige Kaisui Kambrook Kamp Kangli Kangyi Kapsch Karcher Kathrein Kawa Kawasho KB Aristocrat KDS KEC Kendo Kennedy Kennex Kenwood Khind KIC Kiota Kioto Kiton KLH KLL Kloss Kneissel Kolin Kolster Kongque Konichi Konig Konka Kontakt Korpel Korting Kosmos Koyoda Kreisen KTV Kuaile Kulun Kunlun L Kyoshu Kyoto L&S Electronic Lark LaSAT Lavis Leader Lecson Legend Lenco Lenoir Lexsor Leyco LG Liesenk & Tter Liesenkotter Lifetec Lihua Lloyd’s Local India TV Local Malaysia TV Lodos Loewe Logik Logix Longjiang Luker Luma Lumatron Lux May Luxor LXI M M Electronic Madison MAG Magnadyne Magnafon Magnasonic 10418 10163, 10217 10714, 10808, 10865 10154 10486 11037 10009 10037 10009 10037, 10374, 10587 10009 11196 10037, 10264 10054, 11265, 10060, 10178, 10030, 11758, 11637, 11191, 11178, 10856, 10715, 10714, 10700, 10698, 10556, 10370, 10361, 10217, 10163, 10109, 10108, 10037, 10009, 10001 10037 10037, 10327 10009, 10037, 10218, 10374, 10668, 10683, 10714, 11037, 11137 10817 10236, 10180, 10030, 10001, 10009, 11904 10009, 10208, 10602 10698 11037 10037, 10370, 10512, 10633, 10790 10236, 10180, 10060, 10001, 10009, 10011, 10371, 10698, 10773, 10880, 11037, 11217 10668 10264, 10817 11982 10009, 10163, 10362, 10374, 11037 10037, 10073, 10163, 10217, 10264, 10361, 10556 10009, 10037 10163, 10208, 10217, 10346, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10631, 11037, 11163 10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10093, 10060, 10053, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10166, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10001, 10208 10009, 10037, 10109, 10163, 10195, 10217, 10287, 10343, 10346, 10374, 10480, 10512, 10634, 10661, 10714 10037 11498 10054, 10163 10073 10054, 10000, 10156, 10093, 10030, 10092, 10109 Magnavox Magnum Majestic Mandor Manesth Manhattan Marantz Mark Master’s Mastro Masuda Matsui Matsushita Maxdorf Maxent Maxim MCE Meck Mediator Medion Megapower Megas Megatron MEI Meile Memorex Memphis Mercury Mermaid Metronic Metz MGA MGN Technology Micro Genius Micromaxx Microstar MicroTEK Midland Mikomi 10047, 11454, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10250, 10051, 10180, 10060, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10706, 11944, 11904, 11755, 11254, 10802, 10780, 10011, 10035, 10037, 10036 10037, 10648, 10714, 10715 10017 10264 10035, 10037, 10217, 10264 10037, 10668, 10778, 10876, 11037, 11267 11454, 10054, 10030, 10037, 10556, 10704, 10855 10009, 10037, 10217, 10374, 10714, 10715 10499 10053, 10706, 10698, 10780 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10371 11037, 10744, 10714, 10556, 10487, 10455, 10443, 10433, 10371, 10352, 10335, 10217, 10208, 10195, 10163, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10011, 10009 10250, 10051, 10650 10773 11755, 11756 11556, 11982 10009 10698 10037, 10556 10037, 10512, 10556, 10668, 10698, 10714, 10808, 10880, 11037, 11137, 11248, 11900 10700 10610 10047, 10178, 10145, 10009 11037 10264, 10817 10154, 10250, 10463, 10180, 10150, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10009, 10035, 10037, 10195, 10877, 11037, 11911 10009 10060, 10001, 10009, 10037 10037 10625 10037, 10195, 10367, 10388, 10447, 10587, 10668, 10746, 11163 10150, 10178, 10030, 10218, 10374 10178 10150 10037, 10668, 10714, 10808, 11037 10808 10820, 10860 10047, 10017, 10051 11037, 11149 Minato Minerva Minoka Mirror Mitsubishi Mivar Monaco Monivision Morgan’s Motorola MTC MTlogic Mudan Multitec Multitech Murphy Musikland Mx Onda Myryad N NAD Naiko Nakimura Nanbao Nansheng Narita NAT National NEC Neckermann NEI Neovia Netsat NetTV Neufunk New Tech New World Newave Nikkai Nikkei Nikko Nikkodo 10037, 10556 10070, 10108, 10195, 10487 10037 11900 10154, 10250, 10093, 10236, 10180, 11250, 10150, 10178, 10030, 11917, 11037, 10836, 10817, 10556, 10512, 10195, 10108, 10037, 10036, 10011 10217 10009 10700, 10843 10037 10054, 10051, 10093, 10150 10180, 10060, 10030, 10092, 10011, 10370, 10512 10714 10051, 10009, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10817 10037, 10486, 10668, 11037, 11556 10180, 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264, 10370, 10486 10163 10218 11498 10556 10156, 10178, 10166, 10037, 10361, 10866, 11156 10037, 10606, 11982 10037, 10374 10009, 10264 10264, 10817 11982 10226 10051, 10208, 10226, 10508 10047, 10154, 10156, 10051, 10053, 10178, 10030, 11704, 11270, 11170, 10817, 10704, 10661, 10653, 10508, 10499, 10455, 10374, 10264, 10217, 10170, 10036, 10011, 10009 10037, 10200, 10327, 10370, 10418, 10556 10037, 10163, 10371 10865, 10876, 11371 10037 11755 10009, 10037, 10218, 10556, 10610, 10714 10009, 10037, 10217, 10343, 10556 10218 10093, 10178, 10092, 10009 10009, 10035, 10036, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10218, 10264 10714 10178, 10030, 10092 10178, 10030, 10092 Nishi Nobliko Nogamatic Nokia Norcent Nordic Nordmende O Normerel Novatronic NTC Nu-Tec Nyon Oceanic Odeon Okano Olevia Omega Omni Onida Onimax Onwa Opera Optimus Optoma Optonica Orbit Orcom Orion Orline Ormond Osaki Osio Oso Osume Otic Otto Versand P Pace Pacific Palladium Palsonic Panama Panashiba 10030 10070 10109 10163, 10208, 10346, 10361, 10374, 10480, 10548, 10606, 10610, 10631 10748, 10824 10217 10037, 10109, 10195, 10287, 10343, 10560, 10714 10037 10037, 10374 10092 10455, 10698, 10820 10000 10163, 10208, 10361, 10548 10264 10009, 10037, 10264, 10370 11144, 11240, 11331, 11610 10264 10748, 10698, 10780, 10872 10053, 11253 10714 10180, 10218, 10371, 10433, 10602 10037 10154, 10250, 10093, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10030, 10166, 10650 10887 10093 10037 11504 10017, 10236, 10463, 10180, 10178, 11463, 10011, 10037, 10264, 10443, 10556, 10714, 10880, 11196, 11911 10037, 10218 10668, 11037 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10374, 10556 10037 10218 10036, 10037, 10218 11498 10093, 10036, 10037, 10109, 10195, 10217, 10226, 10343, 10361, 10512, 10556 10092 10037, 10443, 10556, 10714, 11037, 11137 10037, 10163, 10200, 10217, 10327, 10370, 10418, 10556, 10714, 11137 10001, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10418, 10698, 10773, 10778, 11196, 11269, 11904 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264 10001 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 7 2007/09/28 12:59:22 Panasonic Panavision Panda Pathe Cinema Pathe Marconi Pausa Paxonic PCE Penney Perdio Perfekt Petters Philco Philharmonic Philips Phocus Phoenix Phonola Pilot Pioneer Pionier Plantron Playsonic Polaroid Poppy Portland Powerpoint Prandoni-Prince Precision Premier President Prima Princeton Prinston Prinz Prism 10054, 10000, 10156, 10250, 10051, 10236, 10030, 11947, 11946, 11941, 11480, 11310, 11291, 11271, 10853, 10650, 10548, 10508, 10367, 10361, 10226, 10208, 10163, 10108, 10037, 10035 10037 10051, 10706, 10009, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10508, 10698, 10780, 10817, 10821 10163 10109 10009 10060, 10030 Profex Profi Profilo Profitronic 10156, 10060 10047, 10000, 10156, 10250, 10051, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10035, 10036, 10037, 10070, 10108, 11347 10037, 10163 10037 11523 10054, 10451, 10463, 10180, 10178, 10030, 10145, 11661, 10037, 10074, 10163, 10370, 10418 10217 11454, 10054, 10017, 10000, 10051, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10092, 11961, 11756, 11254, 10690, 10556, 10512, 10374, 10361, 10343, 10200, 10108, 10037, 10009 10714 10037, 10163, 10370, 10486 10037, 10556 10051, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10706, 10011 10166, 10011, 10037, 10109, 10163, 10170, 10287, 10361, 10370, 10486, 10512, 10679, 10760, 10866, 11260 10370, 10486, 11556 10009, 10037, 10264 10037, 10217, 10714, 10715 10765, 10865, 11276, 11316, 11341, 11498, 11523 10009 10451, 10092, 10374 10037, 10487, 10698 10361 10236, 10180, 10217 10009, 10264 10860 10761, 10009, 10264, 10783, 10815, 10817, 11269, 11933 10700 11037 10361 10250, 10051 Proton 10009, 10163, 10361 10009 11556 10037 10037, 10073, 10625, 10634, 11037 11447, 10047, 11347, 11922 10156 10037, 10217, 10370, 10371, 10374, 10668, 10714 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264, 10418, 10486, 10668, 11037 10178, 10030, 10001, 10009 Proview 11498 ProVision Pulsar Pulser Pvision Pye Pymi 10037, 10556, 10714, 11037 10017, 10092 10178, 10092 10876, 11191 10037, 10374, 10556 10009 10051, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10817 10051, 10218 10150, 10178 10250, 10051, 10009, 10035, 10650, 10865 10011, 10037, 10070, 10074, 10109, 10195, 10200, 10327, 10361, 10512, 10668, 11037 10036 10036 10037 10047 10163, 10218 10037, 10217, 10556 10037 10047, 10154, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10030, 10037, 11904 10009, 10037, 10264, 10370, 10418, 10648, 10668, 11037 10070 10036, 10602 10070 11447, 10047, 11454, 10054, 10000, 10051, 10093, 10178, 10030, 10092, 11958, 11953, 11948, 11922, 11917, 11547, 11347, 11247, 11147, 11047, 10679, 10625, 10560, 10090 10047, 10154, 10180, 10150, 10178, 10030 10037, 10418 10037 10036, 10163, 10346, 10361, 10548 10037 10037, 10668, 11037 10865, 10876, 10877, 11207, 11298 Proline Proscan Prosco Prosonic Protec Protech Q Qingdao Quadral Quartz Quasar Quelle R Questa Questar R-Line Rabbit Radialva Radiola Radiomarelli RadioShack Radiotone Rank Rank Arena RBM RCA Realistic Recor Rectiligne Rediffusion Redstar Reflex Relisys Remotec Reoc Revox Rex RFT Rinex Roadstar Rolson Rover Rowa Royal Lux Runco Ruyi S Saba Sagem Saige Saisho Saivod Sakai Sakyno Salora Salsa Sampo Samsung Sandra Sanjian Sanky Sansui Santon Sanyo Sanyong Sanyuan Saville 10250, 10093, 10145, 10171, 10037 10714 10037 10163, 10264 10037, 10264 10773 10009, 10037, 10218, 10264, 10418, 10668, 10714, 11037, 11900 11371 10036, 10877 10748, 10009, 10037, 10264, 10587, 10698, 10712, 10817 10335, 10370 10017, 10060, 10030 10817 10250, 10109, 10163, 10287, 10335, 10343, 10361, 10498, 10548, 10560, 10625, 10714 10455, 10610, 10618 10009, 10817 10009, 10011, 10163, 10217, 10264 10037, 10668, 10712, 11037, 11163, 11556, 11982 10163 10455 10163, 10208, 10361, 10480, 10548, 10631 10335 10047, 10154, 10093, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10009, 10036, 10650, 10700, 11755, 11756 10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10156, 10093, 10060, 10812, 10702, 10178, 10030, 10092, 10814, 10766, 10718, 10618, 10587, 10817, 10821, 11060, 11249, 11312, 11903, 11959, 10556, 10371, 10370, 10362, 10264, 10226, 10217, 10208, 10163, 10090, 10037, 10036, 10035, 10009 10217 10264 10060, 10030 10463, 10060, 10030, 10706, 10037, 10371, 10455, 10602, 10714, 10861, 11371, 11537, 11904, 11911 10009 10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10463, 10180, 10145, 10171, 11755, 11208, 10704, 10508, 10370, 10264, 10217, 10208, 10170, 10163, 10108, 10088, 10037, 10036, 10011, 10009 10037 10093, 10009, 10817 10060 SBR Sceptre Schaub Lorenz Schneider Scotch Scotland Scott Sears Seaway Seelver SEG SEI Sei-Sinudyne Seleco Semivox Semp Sencora Sentra Serino Shancha Shanghai Shaofeng Sharp Shen Ying Shencai Sheng Chia Shenyang Sherwood Shintoshi Shivaki Show Siarem Siemens Siera Siesta Signature Silva Silva Schneider Silvano Silver SilverCrest 10037, 10556 11217 10361, 10374, 10486, 10548, 10606, 10714, 11191 11982, 11904, 11137, 11037, 10714, 10668, 10648, 10556, 10394, 10371, 10361, 10352, 10343, 10218, 10217, 10163, 10070, 10037 10178 10163 10236, 10180, 10178, 10030 10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10093, 10060, 10053, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10166, 10035, 10036, 10037, 10001, 10208, 11904 10634 11037 10009, 10036, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10362, 10487, 10668, 11037, 11163 10037, 10163 10037 10163, 10264, 10346, 10362, 10371 10180 10156 10009 10035 10093, 10455, 10610 10264, 10817 10009, 10208, 10226, 10264, 10817 10145, 10817 10054, 10093, 10180, 10053, 10030, 10009, 10036, 10200, 10650, 10653, 10668, 11193, 11393, 11917 10092, 10009 10145, 10009, 10264 10093, 10236, 10009 10009, 10264, 10817 10009 10037 10178, 10037, 10374, 10443, 10556 10009, 10418 10163 10145, 10037, 10195, 10200, 10327 10037, 10556 10370 10047, 10093, 10030 10037, 10361, 10648 10037, 11556 10587 10036, 10361, 10455, 10715 11037 Simpson 10178, 10030, 10011 10060, 10092, 10009, 10037, 10335, 10371, 10433, 11537 Sinotec 10773 Sinudyne 10037, 10163, 10361 Skantic 10163 SKY 10037, 10880, 11504 Sky Brazil 10880 Sky-North 10037 Skygiant 10180 10748, 10009, 10037, 10264, Skyworth 10698, 10805, 10817, 11115 Sliding 10865, 10880 SLX 10668 Smaragd 10487 Soemtron 10865, 11298 Solar Drape 10000 Solavox 10037, 10163, 10361, 10548 Sole 10813 Sonawa 10218 Songba 10009 Soniko 10037 Sonitron 10208, 10217, 10370 Sonneclair 10037 Sonoko 10009, 10037, 10217, 10264 Sonolor 10163, 10208, 10361, 10548 Sontec 10009, 10037, 10370 10017, 10154, 11100, 10000, 10150, 10053, 10011, 10036, Sony 10037, 10074, 10353, 10650, 11505, 11651, 11751, 11904 Sound & Vision 10218, 10374 Soundesign 10180, 10178 Soundwave 10037, 10418, 10715 Sova 11952 10156, 10051, 10060, 10178, Sowa 10092, 10036, 10226 Soyea 10773 Spectra 10009 Spectravision 10156, 10178 Spectroniq 11498 Squareview 10171 SR2000 10154, 10171 Ssangyong 10009 SSS 10180 Staksonic 10009 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, Standard 10374, 11037 Standard Components 10009, 10218 10236, 10180, 10009, 10037, Starlite 10163, 10264 Stenway 10218 Stern 10163, 10264 Stevison 11982 Strato 10009, 10037, 10264 Singer PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 8 2007/09/28 12:59:24 Strong Studio Experience Stylandia Sunkai Sunstar Sunwatt Sunwood Superla Superscan Supersonic SuperTech Supra Supreme Susumu Sutron SV2000 SVA Svasa Swisstec Sydney Sylvania Symphonic Synco T Syntax Sysline T+A Tacico Tai Yi Taishan Tandberg Tandy Targa Tashiko Tatung TCL TCM Teac Tec Tech Line Techica Technica 11149, 11163 10843 10217 10218, 10455, 10487, 10610, 10865 10009, 10037, 10264, 10371 10455 10037 10217 10093, 10864, 11944 10009, 10208, 10455, 10805 10009, 10037, 10218, 10556 10178, 10009, 10374 10000 10218, 10287, 10335 10009 10054 10748, 10587, 10865, 10870, 10871, 10872 10455 10880, 11504 10217 10047, 10054, 10154, 10000, 10051, 10178, 10030, 10171, 10092, 10036, 10037, 10876, 11271, 11904, 11944 10000, 10180, 10178, 10171, 11904, 11944 10000, 10451, 10093, 10060, 10178, 10092, 10036 11144, 11240, 11331 10037 10447 10178, 10092, 10009 10009 10009, 10374, 10817 10109, 10361, 10367 10093, 10163, 10217, 10218 11371 10092, 10036, 10163, 10170, 10217, 10650 10054, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10060, 10037, 10036, 10011, 10009, 10217, 11156, 11191, 11248, 11254, 11371, 11556, 11756 10706, 10698, 11027, 11537 10714, 10808 10154, 10178, 10171, 10706, 11755, 11149, 11037, 10714, 10712, 10698, 10668, 10512, 10455, 10418, 10264, 10217, 10170, 10037, 10009 10009, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10335 10037, 10668, 11163 10218 11982 Technics TechniSat Technisson Technosonic Technovox Techview Techwood Tecnimagen Teco Tedelex Teiron Tek Teknika Tele System Electronic Teleavia Telecolor Telecor Telefunken Telefusion Telegazi Telemeister Telesonic Telestar Teletech Teleton Televideon Teleview Tempest Tennessee Tensai Tenson Tera Tevion Texet Texla ThemeScene Thomas Thomson Thorn Thorn-Ferguson 10054, 10250, 10051, 10226, 10556, 10650 10556, 11267 10714 10499, 10556 10030, 10217 10847 10250, 10051, 10060, 11163 10556 10051, 10093, 10178, 10092, 10009, 10036, 10218, 10264, 10653, 11040 10009, 10208, 10217, 10418, 10606, 10698, 11537 10009 10820 10054, 10463, 10180, 10150, 10060, 10178, 10092 Tiane Tiny TMK TML TNCi Tobishi Tobo Tocom Tokai Tokaido Tokyo Tomashi Tongguang Tongtel Topline 10876 10287, 10343 10017 10037, 10163, 10217, 10218, 10394 10702, 11504, 10821, 10820, 10819, 10714, 10712, 10698, 10625, 10587, 10560, 10498, 10486, 10346, 10343, 10335, 10287, 10109, 10074, 10073, 10037 10037 10037, 10163, 10218, 10264 10037 10037 10009, 10037, 10556 10009, 10037, 10668, 11037 10036, 10217 10163 10037 10009, 10264, 10455 10037 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10371, 10374, 10715, 11037 10009 10030, 10092 10037, 10556, 10648, 10668, 10714, 10808, 11037, 11137, 11248, 11298, 11498, 11556 10009, 10217, 10218, 10374 10780 10887 10047, 10178, 10001, 11904 11447, 10047, 10037, 10109, 10287, 10335, 10343, 10560, 10625 10035, 10036, 10037, 10073, 10074, 10109, 10163, 10264, 10335, 10343, 10361, 10499, 10512 10073, 10335, 10343, 10499 Toshiba Totevision Towada Toyoda Toyomenka Trakton Trans Continens TRANS-continents Transonic Triad Trident Trio Tristar Triumph Truetone Tuntex TVS TVTEXT 95 U Uher Ultra Ultravox Unic Line United Universal Universum 10093, 10817 11269 10236, 10180, 10178 11756 10017 10218 10748, 10009, 10264 10156 10009, 10037, 10163, 10217, 10374, 10668, 11037 11037 10035 10218 10264 10587, 10780 10668, 11037 10154, 11256, 10156, 10150, 11265, 10060, 11145, 10145, 10166, 11037, 11156, 11163, 11164, 11356, 11508, 11556, 11656, 11704, 11945, 11971, 10845, 10821, 10718, 10650, 10618, 10508, 10264, 10217, 10195, 10109, 10070, 10036, 10035, 10011, 10009 10051 10217 10009, 10264, 10371 10178 10217, 10264 10037, 10217, 10668, 11037 10556, 10865 10009, 10037, 10264, 10418, 10455, 10512, 10587, 10698, 10712, 10780 10218, 10556 10217 11498 10218, 10264 10037, 10346, 10556 10250, 10051 10030, 10092, 10009 10463 10556 10037, 10370, 10374, 10418, 10480, 10486 10092 10037, 10163, 10374 10037, 10455 10037, 10587, 10714, 10715, 11037, 11982 10047, 10037 11163, 11037, 10668, 10631, 10618, 10512, 10480, 10418, 10370, 10362, 10361, 10346, 10327, 10264, 10217, 10200, 10195, 10170, 10109, 10074, 10070, 10037, 10036, 10011, 10009 V Univox V V2max V7 Videoseven Vector Research Vestel Vexa Victor Videocon Videologic Videologique Videomac VideoSystem Videotechnic Videoton Vidikron Vidtech Viewpia Viewsonic Viking Viore Vision Vizio Vortec Voxson W Waltham Wards Warumaia Watson Watt Radio Waycon Wega Wegavox Weipai Welltech Weltblick Welton Weltstar Westinghouse Wharfedale White Westinghouse Windsor Windy Sam Wintel World 10037, 10163 10864, 10885, 11755, 11756 10865 10880, 11217, 11755 10030 10037, 10217, 10668, 11037, 11163 10009, 10037 10250, 10053, 10036, 10650, 10653 10508 10218 10217, 10218 10009 10037 10217, 10374 10163 10054 10178, 10036 10876 10857, 10864, 10885, 11330, 11578, 11627, 11755 10060 11207 10037, 10217, 10264 10864, 10885, 11755, 11756, 11758 10037 10178, 10037, 10163, 10418 10037, 10109, 10217, 10418, 10443, 10668, 11037 10047, 10054, 10017, 10154, 10000, 10156, 10051, 10093, 10236, 10180, 10060, 10178, 10030, 10166, 11347, 11156, 11147, 10866, 10195, 10001, 10037, 10035 10374, 10661 10009, 10037, 10163, 10218, 10394, 10668, 10714, 11037 10163 10156 10036, 10037 10009 10009 10714 10217 10178 11037 10000, 10451, 10885, 10889, 11282, 11577 10037, 10556, 10860, 11556 10451, 10236, 10463, 10037, 10623, 10889, 11909 10668, 11037 10556 10714 10451, 10236, 10463, 10180 World-of-Vision X Worldview X-View Xenius Xiahua Y Xianghai Xiangyang Xiangyu Xihu Xingfu Xinghai XLogic Xoceco Xoro XR-1000 Xrypton Yamaha Yamishi Yapshe Yingge Yokan Yoko Z Yonggu Yorx Youlanasi Yousida Yuhang Zanussi Zenith ZhuHai 10865, 10877, 10880, 11217, 11298 10455 11191 10634, 10661 10009, 10264, 10698, 10773, 10817 10009 10264 10009 10264, 10817 10009 10264 10698, 10860 11064 11196, 11217 10154, 10180, 10171 10037 10030, 10650, 11576 10037, 10217, 10218, 10455 10250 10009 10037 10009, 10037, 10217, 10218, 10264, 10370 10009 10030, 10218 10817 10009 10009 10163, 10217, 10264 10047, 10017, 10000, 10093, 10463, 11265, 10812, 10178, 10030, 11145, 10145, 10171, 10092, 10037, 11904, 11909, 11911 10009, 10374 TV/DVD Combination b2, b4 b2 A B C D Advent Akai Akura Alba Amstrad Apex Digital Audiovox Axion Black Diamond Bush Centrum Crown D-Vision Denver 11933 11675 11982 11037 11982 11943 11937, 11951, 11952 11937, 11958 11037 10698, 11037, 11900 11037 11037 11982 10587 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 9 2007/09/28 12:59:25 E F G H J K L M N P R S T U V Elfunk Ferguson Finlux Goodmans Hitachi JDV Jensen KLH Lenco Logik Luker Luxor Matsui Maxim Medion Mirror Naiko Narita Panasonic Philips Powerpoint Prima RCA Roadstar Saivod Samsung Schneider SEG Sova Stevison Sylvania Teac Technica Telefunken Thomson Transonic United Vestel 11037 11037 11556 10587, 11037, 11900 11960 11982 11933 11962 10587 11037 11982 11037 11037 11982 11900 11900 11982 11982 11941 11454, 10556, 11961 10698 11933 11948, 11958 11900 11982 11903 11982 11037 11952 11982 10171 10698 11982 10698 10625 10587 10587, 11037, 11982 11037 b4 A B C D 10 Akai Akura Alba Amstrad Apex Digital Black Diamond Broksonic Bush Centrum Citizen Crown D-Vision 30695 31367 30695, 30884 31367 30830 30713, 30884 30695 30713, 30884 30713 30695 30713 31367 E F G H I J K L M N O P R S T U V DMTech Elfunk Emerson ESA Ferguson Funai Goodmans Grandin Grundig Hitachi Insignia JDV JNC Konka Logik Luker Luxor Magnavox Matsui Maxim Naiko Narita Neovia Orion Pacific Panasonic Philips RCA Saivod Samsung Sansui Schneider SEG Sliding Stevison Sylvania Technica Thomson Toshiba United Universum Vestel 31271 30713, 30884 30675, 31268 31268 30695, 30713, 30884 31268 30713 30713 30539, 30695 31247 31268 31367 31271 31192 30713, 30884 31367 30713 31268 30713, 30884 31367 31367 31367 31271 30695 30695 31490 30539, 30854, 31260 31022 31367 30899 30695 31367 30713, 30884 31115 31367 30630, 30675, 31268 31367 30551 30695 30713, 30884, 31367 30713 30884 C D E F Broksonic Bush Curtis Mathes Daewoo Emerson Ferguson Fidelity Funai G GE H I J L M O P Q R RCA S T TV/VCR Combination b2, b3, b4 b2 A B Aiwa America Action Amstrad Audiovox Beko Black Diamond 11904, 11911 10180 10171 10180 10486 11909 GoldStar Goodmans Grundig Harley Davidson Hinari Hitachi Internal JVC LG Lloyd’s Magnavox Memorex Mitsubishi Orion Palsonic Panasonic Penney Philips Quasar Radiola RadioShack W Z Saba Samsung Sansui Schneider Sears Sharp Siemens Sony Sylvania Symphonic Teac Technics Thomas Thomson Toshiba White Westinghouse Zenith 10463, 11911 11556 10051 11909 10236, 10463, 11909, 11911 10073, 10625 10171 11904 10047, 10051, 10093, 11917, 11922 10037 10374, 11909 10037, 10195, 10556 11904 10036 11904 11909 11923 10178 11904 10054, 11904 10250 10093, 10556, 11917 10463, 11911 11904 10250, 10051 10051 10037, 10556 10250, 10051 10556 11904 10047, 10051, 10093, 11917, 11922 10625 11959 10463, 11904, 11911 10037, 10556, 11904 11904 10093, 11917 10037 10000, 11505, 11904 10054 11904 10178, 10171 10556 11904 10625 11971 11909 11904, 11909, 11911 b3 A Aiwa 20000, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21137 B C D Akai Alba America Action Amstrad Audiovox Beko Bestar Blue Sky BPL Broksonic Bush Citizen Curtis Mathes Daewoo Dantax E F Emerson G GE H I J K L M Ferguson Fidelity Firstline Funai GoldStar Goodmans Grandin Grundig Hanimex Harley Davidson Hinari Hitachi Hypson Internal JBL JMB Kambrook Kneissel LG Lloyd’s Loewe Magnasonic Magnavox Magnin Matsui Medion Memorex O MGA Mitsubishi Optimus Orion P Pace Pacific 20352 20352 20278 20000 20278 20104 20278 20278, 20352, 20742 20046 20002, 20479, 21479 20352, 20742 20278, 21278 20035, 21035 20278, 20637, 21278 20352 20002, 20278, 20479, 20637, 21278, 21479 20000, 20278 20000 20278 20000 20060, 20035, 20048, 20240, 20807, 21035, 21060 20037, 20480, 21237 20278, 20352, 20637 20278, 20742 20081, 20347, 20352, 20742 20352 20000 20352 20000 20037 20278, 20637 20278 20352 20037 20278, 20352 20037, 20480, 21237 20000 20037 20278, 21278 20081, 20000, 21781 20240 20352, 20742 20352 20162, 20037, 21162, 21237, 21262 20240 20048, 20081, 20043, 20807 20162, 21162, 21262 20002, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21479 20352 20742 Palsonic Panasonic Penney Q R Philips Portland Quasar Radiola RadioShack RCA S T U W Z Saba Samsung Sansui Sanyo Saville Schneider Sears SEG Sharp Shivaki Siemens Sinudyne Sony Supra Sylvania Symphonic Tatung Teac Technics Technosonic Telefunken Thomas Thomson Toshiba United White Westinghouse Zenith 20000 20035, 20162, 21035, 21162, 21262 20035, 20037, 20240, 21035, 21237 20081 20637 20035, 20162, 21035, 21162 20081 20000 20060, 20035, 20048, 20240, 20807, 21035, 21060 20320 20240, 20432, 21014 20000, 20479, 21479 20240 20352 20081, 20000 20037, 20000, 21237 20637 20037, 20048, 20807 20037 20081 20352 20032, 20000, 21232 20348 20081, 21781 20000 20352 20037, 20000, 20637, 20642 20081 20352 20278 20000 20278 20352, 20432, 20845, 21145 20742 20278, 20637 20000, 20479, 20637, 21479 b4 T Thomson 30551 TV/VCR/DVD Combination b2, b3, b4 b2 A B E M P R Akai Broksonic Emerson ESA Magnavox Panasonic RCA 11903 11938 11944 11944 11944 11946, 11947 11953 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 10 2007/09/28 12:59:27 S T Sharp Sylvania Symphonic Toshiba 11917 11944 11944 11945 b3 S Sharp 20807 Akai Emerson ESA Magnavox Panasonic RCA Sharp Superscan Sylvania Symphonic Toshiba 30899 30821 30821 30821 31362, 31462 31132 30630 30821 30821 30821 31045 b4 A E M P R S T B VCR A 20037, 20240, 20000, 20278, 20046 21972 20060, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20104, 20121, 20209, 20479 20037, 20240, 20000 20278 20278, 20348, 20642 20037, 20032, 20000, 20209, 20041, 20348, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21137 20037, 20240, 20041, 20106, 20315, 20348, 20352, 20642 20041 20081, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20315, 20348, 20352 21972 20039, 21137 20240 20081 20278 20035, 20081 20479 20000, 20278 20162, 20037, 20240, 20278, 20226, 20480 20162, 20226, 21162, 21562 20000 20081 20037, 20081 20240 20035, 20240 20037, 20081, 20000, 20038 A-Mark ABS Admiral Adventura Aiko Aim Aiwa Akai Akura Alba Alienware Allegro Allorgan Allstar America Action American High Amoisonic Amstrad Anam Anam National Ansonic Aristona ASA Asha Astra Asuka C 20081 20278 20037, 20278, 20038 20000 20000, 20352 20037, 20043, 20278, 20642 20000, 20104, 20041, 20278, Baird 20046, 20106 Basic Line 20104, 20278, 20046 Beaumark 20240 Beko 20104 20035, 20048, 20039, 20000, Bell & Howell 20104, 20046, 20479 Bestar 20278 Black Diamond 20642 Black Panther 20278 Blaupunkt 20162, 20081, 20226 20037, 20209, 20278, 20348, Blue Sky 20352, 20480, 20642, 20742, 21137 BPL 20046 Brandt 20041, 20320 Brandt Electronique 20041 Brinkmann 20209, 20348 20184, 20121, 20209, 20002, Broksonic 20348, 20479, 21479 20081, 20000, 20209, 20278, Bush 20315, 20348, 20352, 20642, 20742 Calix 20037 Candle 20037, 20038 Canon 20035 Capehart 20002 Carena 20081, 20209 Carrefour 20045 Carrera 20240 Carver 20035, 20081 Casio 20000 Cathay 20278 CCE 20278 CGE 20000, 20041 Changhong 20048, 20081 Cimline 20209 Cineral 20278 CineVision 21137 20035, 20037, 20240, 20000, Citizen 20209, 20278, 20479, 21278 Classic 20037 Clatronic 20000, 21593 Colortyme 20060, 20035, 20045, 20278 Colt 20000 Combitech 20352 Condor 20278 Craig 20037, 20047, 20240 Criterion 20000 Crosley Crown Audiolab Audiosonic Audiovox Avis AVP Awa Curtis Mathes Cybernex CyberPower Cyrus D Daewoo Dansai Dantax Daytron De Graaf Decca Degraff Deitron Dell Denon Derwent Diamant Diamond Digitor DirecTV Domland DSE Dual E Dumont Durabrand Dynatech Elbe Electrohome Electrophonic Elin Elta Emerald Emerex Emerson ESA ESC EuroLine F Ferguson Fidelity Finlandia Finlux 20035, 20081, 20000 20037, 20278, 20480 20060, 20035, 20162, 20240, 20000, 20041, 20278, 20432, 21035 20240 21972 20081 20037, 20045, 20104, 20209, 20278, 20046, 20352, 20637, 20642, 21137, 21278 20278 20352 20037, 20278 20048, 20081, 20042, 20104, 20046 20081, 20000, 20067, 20209, 20041, 20352 20048, 20081, 20042, 20104 20278 21972 20081, 20042 20041 20037 20348 20642 20739 20209 20642 20081, 20000, 20041, 20278, 20348 20081, 20000, 20104 20039, 20038, 20642 20240, 20000 20278, 20038 20060, 20037, 20240, 20000, 20043, 20209 20037 20240 20278 20184, 20121 20032 20035, 20037, 20184, 20039, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20121, 20043, 20209, 20002, 20278, 20348, 20479, 20637, 21278, 21479, 21593 21137 20240, 20278 21593 20000, 20041, 20278, 20320, 20348 20240, 20000, 20352, 20432 20037, 20048, 20081, 20000, 20042, 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106, 20226 20081, 20000, 20042, 20104 Firstline Fisher G Flint Fuji Fujitsu Fujitsu General Funai Galaxi Galaxis Garrard Gateway GE GEC Gemini General General Technic Genexxa Go Video GoldStar Goodmans GPX Gradiente Graetz Granada Grandin Grundig H Haaz Hanimex Hanseatic Haojie Harley Davidson Harman/Kardon Headquarter Hewlett Packard HI-Q Hinari Hisawa Hischito Hitachi Hoeher Hornyphon Howard Computers HP 20037, 20045, 20042, 20043, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20480, 21137 20039, 20047, 20000, 20104, 20046 20209, 20348 20035, 20033 20037, 20045, 20000 20037 20037, 20000, 20278, 21593 20000 20278 20000 21972 20060, 20035, 20048, 20240, 20000, 20226, 20320, 20807, 21035, 21060 20081 20060 20045 20348 20037, 20000, 20104, 20278 20240, 20432, 20614, 21137 20035, 20037, 20039, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20038, 20225, 20226, 20480, 21137, 21237 20037, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20637, 20642, 20742 20037 20000 20240, 20104, 20041 20035, 20037, 20048, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20042, 20104, 20046, 20226 20037, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20742 20081, 20226, 20320, 20347, 20348, 20352, 20742 20348 20352 20037, 20081, 20209, 20038 20240 20000 20081, 20038 20046 21972 20035, 20047, 20000 20240, 20209, 20041, 20278, 20352 20209, 2035 20045 20035, 20037, 20081, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20041, 20046, 20089 20278, 20642 20081 21972 21972 Hughes Network Systems Humax Hush Hypson I Hytek iBUYPOWER Imperial Ingersol Interbuy Interfunk Internal International Intervision Irradio ITT J ITT Nokia ITV Janeil JBL Jensen JMB Joyce JVC K Kambrook Karcher KEC Kendo Kenwood KIC Kimari Kneissel L Kodak Kolin Kolster KTV Kuba Kuba Electronic Lenco LG Lifetec Linksys Lloyd’s Loewe Logik Lumatron Lunatron 20042, 20739 20739 21972 20037, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20352, 20480 20047, 20000 21972 20000 20240, 20209 20037 20081, 20104 20278, 20637 20037, 20278, 20642 20037, 20000, 20209, 20278, 20348 20037, 20081, 21137 20240, 20104, 20041, 20046, 20106 20240, 20104, 20041, 20106 20037, 20278 20240 20278 20067, 20041 20209, 20348, 20352, 20742 20000 20184, 20081, 20045, 20067, 20041, 21162 20037 20081, 20278, 20642 20037, 20278 20037, 20209, 20278, 20106, 20315, 20348, 20642 20067, 20041, 20038, 20046 20000 20047 20037, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20352 20035, 20037 20043, 20041 20209 20000 20047 20047 20278 20037, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20209, 20278, 20038, 20225, 20480, 21137, 21237 20209, 20348 21972 20240, 20000, 20038 21062, 20162, 20037, 20081, 21262, 21562 20240, 20000, 20209, 20106 20278, 21137 21137 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 11 11 2007/09/28 12:59:28 20048, 20047, 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106, 20315 20037, 20000, 20042, 20067 20037, 20240, 20000, 20038 20081 20037, 20240, 20000, 20278, 21278 20035, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20226, 20618, 20642, 21593, 21781 20240 20642 20081, 20045, 20209 20035, 20081, 20209, 20038 20000, 20278 20037 20642 20278 20037, 20240, 20209, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20742 20035, 20162, 20081, 20226, 21162 21972 20081 20209, 20348, 20352, 20642 20035 20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20209, 20278, 20046, 20348, 20479, 21162, 21237, 21262 20081 21062, 20162, 20037, 20081, 20226, 20347, 20836, 21162, 21262, 21562 20060, 20240, 20043 20240 20348 20209 21972 20240 20000 21972 20042 20060, 20048, 20047, 20081, 20000, 20042, 20067, 20043, 20041, 20480, 20642, 20807 20035, 20048 20240, 20000 20000 20037 20039, 20000 20000 20081 20240, 20104 20348, 20642 20039 20226 Luxor M LXI M Electronic Magnadyne Magnasonic Magnavox Magnin Magnum Manesth Marantz Mark Marta Mastec Master’s Matsui Matsushita Media Center PC Mediator Medion MEI Memorex Metronic Metz MGA MGN Technology Micormay Micromaxx Microsoft Midland Migros Mind Minolta Mitsubishi N 12 Motorola MTC MTX Multitec Multitech Murphy Myryad NAD Naiko NAP National Nebula Electronics NEC Neckermann Nesco Neufunk Newave Nikkai Nikko Nikkodo Nishi Niveus Media Noblex Nokia Nordmende Northgate Nu-Tec O Oceanic Okano Olympus Onimax Onkyo Optimus Orion P Orson Osaki Otake Otto Versand Pace Pacific Packard Bell Palladium Palsonic Panama Panasonic Pathe Cinema Pathe Marconi Penney Pentax Perdio Philco 20033 20035, 20037, 20048, 20104, 20067, 20041, 20278, 20038, 21137 20081, 20041 20000 20209 20037 20278 20037, 20278 20037, 20278 20240 21972 20240 20048, 20081, 20240, 20042, 20104, 20041, 20278, 20046, 20106, 20315 20067, 20041, 20320 21972 20209 20048, 20081, 20000, 20104, 20041, 20046, 20106 20209, 20278, 20315, 20348 20035, 20162, 20104, 20226 20642 20222 21062, 20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20432, 21162, 21262 20184, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20121, 20209, 20002, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20479, 20742, 21479 20000 20037, 20000 20209 20081 20352 20000, 20348, 20642, 20742 21972 20037, 20209, 20041, 20348 20000, 20642 20035 21062, 20035, 20162, 20000, 20225, 20226, 20614, 20616, 20836, 21035, 21162, 21262, 21562 20043 20041 20035, 20162, 20037, 20047, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20042, 20067, 20038, 21035, 21237 20042 20000, 20209 20035, 20081, 20000, 20209, 20038, 20226, 20479 Philips Q Phoenix Phonola Pilot Pioneer Polk Audio Portland Presidian Prinz Profitronic Proline Proscan Prosco Prosonic Protec Protech ProVision Pulsar Pulser Pye Qisheng Quarter Quartz Quasar R Quelle Radialva Radiola Radionette RadioShack Radix Randex Rank Rank Arena RCA Realistic Reoc ReplayTV Rex Ricavision Rio Roadstar S Runco Saba Saisho Salora 20035, 20162, 20048, 20081, 20045, 20000, 20209, 20226, 20616, 20618, 20739, 21081, 21181 20278 20081 20037 20162, 20081, 20042, 20067 20081 20278, 20637 21593 20000 20081, 20240 20000, 20278, 20320, 20642 20060, 21060 20278 20209, 20278 20000 20081 20278 20039, 20240, 20278 20240 20081, 20000 20060 20046 20035, 20047, 20046 20035, 20162, 20002, 20278, 20226, 21035, 21162 20081 20037, 20048, 20081 20081 20037, 21137 20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20046, 21162 20037 20037 20041 20041 20060, 20035, 20048, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20106, 20226, 20320, 20807, 20880, 21035, 21060 20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20121, 20278, 20046, 21162 20348 20614, 20616 20041 21972 21137 20037, 20081, 20240, 20278, 20038, 20742 20039 20041, 20278, 20320 20209, 20348 20104, 20043, 20046, 20106 Sampo Samsung Samtron Sanky Sansei Sansui Sanyo Saville SBR ScanSonic Schaub Lorenz Schneider Scott Sears Seaway SEG SEI Sei-Sinudyne Seleco Semp Sentra Sharp Shinco Shintom Shivaki Shogun Siemens Siera Signature Silva Silver SilverCrest Singer Sinudyne Smaragd Sonic Blue Sonographe Sonolor Sontec Sonwa Sony 20037, 20048 20060, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20038, 20432, 20739, 21014 20240 20048, 20039 20048 20240, 20000, 20067, 20209, 20041, 20002, 20106, 20348, 20479, 21479 20048, 20047, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20067, 20209, 20046, 20348, 20479, 21137 20240, 20278, 20352 20081 20240 20000, 20104, 20041, 20106, 20315, 20348 20037, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20042, 20278, 20348, 20352, 20642, 21137 20184, 20045, 20121, 20043 20060, 20035, 20162, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20033, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20104, 20067, 20043, 20209, 20041, 21237, 20046 20278 20081, 20240, 20278, 20637, 20642 20081 20081 20037, 20041 20045 20278 20037, 20048, 20047, 20032, 20000, 20209, 20807 20000 20039, 20240, 20000, 20104 20037 20240 20037, 20081, 20104, 20046, 20320, 20347 20081 20060, 20035, 20037, 20048, 20000, 20046, 20479 20037 20278 20642 20037, 20240, 20045, 20348 20081, 20209, 20352 20348 20614, 20616, 21137 20046 20048, 20046 20037, 20278 20642 20035, 20048, 20047, 20032, 20033, 20000, 20067, 20046, 20106, 20226, 20636, 21232, 21972 Soundmaster Soundwave Stack 9 Standard Stern STS Sunkai Sunstar Suntronic Supra Susumu SV2000 SVA Sylvania T Symphonic Systemax T+A Tagar Systems Taisho Tandberg Tandy Tashiko Tatung Tchibo TCM Teac Technics TechniSat Technosonic Teco Tedelex Teknika Teleavia Telecorder Telefunken Telerent Telestar Teletech Tensai Tevion Texet Thomas Thomson Thorn Tisonic Tivo TMK 20000 20037, 20209, 20348 21972 20278 20278 20042 20209, 20278, 20348 20000 20000 20037, 20278, 20348 20037 20000 20000 20035, 20081, 20000, 20043, 21593, 21781 20240, 20000, 20002, 21593 21972 20162 21972 20209 20278 20000, 20104 20037, 20048, 20081, 20240, 20000 20048, 20081, 20045, 20000, 20067, 20043, 20209, 20041, 20348, 20352 20348 20348 20037, 20000, 20067, 20041, 20278, 20637, 20642, 21593 20035, 20162, 20037, 20081, 20000, 20226, 21162 20348 20352 20035, 20037, 20048, 20041, 20038 20037, 20209, 20348, 20642 20035, 20037, 20000 20041 20240 20209, 20041, 20278, 20320, 20642 20226 20037 20000, 20278 20037, 20000, 20278 20209, 20348, 20479, 20642 20278 20000, 20002 20060, 20067, 20041, 20278, 20320 20037, 20104, 20041, 20320 20278 20618, 20636, 20739, 21996 20240, 20000 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 12 2007/09/28 12:59:30 TNIX Tocom Tokai Topline 20037 20240 20037, 20104, 20041 20348 20081, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20067, 20043, 20209, 20041, 20352, 20432, 20742, 20845, 21008, 21145, 21972, 21996 20278 20037, 20240 21972 20278 20081 20278 20037 20240 20045, 20278 20278 20240 20348, 20742, 21593 20037, 20081, 20240, 20000, 20104, 20209, 20106, 20348, 21137 20045 20184, 20038 20067, 20041 20045 20000 20037 20240, 20000 21972 20000 21972 20060, 20035, 20037, 20048, 20039, 20047, 20081, 20033, 20240, 20045, 20000, 20042, 20043, 20041, 20038, 20046, 20479 20081, 20352, 20642 20037 20642 20000, 20209, 20278, 20479, 20637 20209, 20002, 20348, 20479 20035, 20240, 20000 20041, 20038 20278 20037, 20240 20037, 20039, 20033, 20000, 20209, 20041, 20278, 20479, 20637, 21137, 21479 21972 20209, 20348, 20352 Toshiba U Tosonic Totevision Touch Toyoda Tradex Triad Trix Uher Ultra Ultravox Unitech United Universum V W X Y Z Vector Vector Research Victor Video Concepts Video Technic Videomagic Videosonic Viewsonic Villain Voodoo Wards Watson Weltblick Wharfedale White Westinghouse World XR-1000 Yamaha Yamishi Yoko Zenith ZT Group ZX PVR b3 A C D G H I L M N P R S T V Z ABS Alienware CyberPower Dell DirecTV Gateway Go Video Hewlett Packard Howard Computers HP Hughes Network Systems Humax Hush iBUYPOWER Linksys Media Center PC Microsoft Mind Niveus Media Northgate Panasonic Philips RCA ReplayTV Samsung Sonic Blue Sony Stack 9 Systemax Tagar Systems Tivo Toshiba Touch Viewsonic Voodoo ZT Group 21972 21972 21972 21972 20739 21972 20614 21972 21972 21972 A 3D LAB 4Kus A-Trend Acoustic Solutions AEG AFK Aim Airis Aiwa Akashi AKI Akira Akura Alba Alco Alize All-Tel Allegro Altacom Amitech Amoi Amphion Media Works Amstrad AMW Anam Ansonic 20739 20739 21972 21972 21972 21972 21972 21972 21972 21972 20614, 20616 20618, 20739 20880 20614, 20616 20739 20614, 20616 20636, 21972 21972 21972 21972 20618, 20636, 20739 21008, 21972, 21996 21972 21972 21972 21972 DVD Player 1 Akai 30503, 30539 31158 30714 30713, 30730, 31228 30770, 30788, 30790, 31923 31051, 31152, 31923 30672, 30699, 30833 30672, 31005, 31224, 31250, 31321, 31345 30533, 30641 Apex Digital B Aristona Arrgo ASCOMTEC Asono Aspire Digital Atacom Audiosonic Audiovox Audioworld Autovox Auvio Awa Axion Base Basic Line Baze BBK Beep Bellagio Belson Binatone Black Diamond Blaupunkt Blu:sens Blue Nova International Blue Parade 30690, 30695, 30705, 30770, 30788, 30790, 30884, 30898, 30899, 31115, 31205, 31233, 31695 30838 31005 30699, 31321 30898, 31051, 31140, 31233, 31367 30672, 30539, 30717, 30695, 30699, 30713, 30730, 30783, 30884, 31140, 31530, 31695 30790 31151 31451 30869 31224 30784, 30770, 30850 30852 C 30872 30713, 30770, 31151, 31367 30872 31913 30759, 30774, 30831 30533, 30672, 30717, 30755, 30794, 30796, 30797, 30830, 31004, 31020, 31056, 31061 30539, 30646 31023 31923 31224 31168 31224 30690, 31923 30717, 30790 30790 30713 30843 30730, 30872 30730 31451 30713 30898 30862, 31224 31163 31004 31086, 31923 31923 30713, 30833, 30884 30717 31233, 31321 31321 30571 30672, 30651, 30695, 30699, 30713, 30790, 30843, 31423 Boghe 31004 Boman 30783, 30898, 31005 Bose 32023 Brainwave 30770, 31115 Brandt 30503, 30651, 30551 Broksonic 30695 30672, 30717, 30690, 30699, 30713, 30723, 30730, 30831, Bush 30833, 30884, 31051, 31140, 31483, 31695, 31832 Byd:sign 30872 C-Tech 30798, 31152 California Audio Labs 30490 Cambridge Audio 30751, 31109 Cambridge 30690 Soundworks Campomatic Digital 31051 Cat 30699, 30789, 31421, 31923 CCE 30730 Celestial 31020 cello 31730 Centrex 30672, 31004 30713, 30789, 31005, 31227, Centrum 31923 CGV 30751, 31115 Changhong 30627, 31061 Cinea 30831, 30841 Cinetec 30713, 30872 cineULTRA 30699 CineVision 30833, 30869, 31483 Citizen 30695 Clairtone 30571 Classic 30730, 31730 Clatronic 30672, 30675, 30788, 31233 Clayton 30713 30730, 30852, 31086, 31321, Coby 31923 Codex 31233 Commax 31321 Conia 30672, 30852, 31321 Contel 30788 Continental Edison 30831, 30872 Craig 30831 Creative 30503, 30539 Crown 30690, 30713, 30770, 31115 Crypto 31228 Curtis Mathes 31087 Cybercom 30831 30714, 30816, 30874, 31023, CyberHome 31024, 31117, 31129, 31502 Cytron 30651, 30705, 30774, 31347 D-Vision 31115, 31367 Daenyx 30872 Blue Sky D Daewoo Dalton Dansai Dantax Daytek Dayton DCE Decca Denon Denver Denzel Desay Dgtec Diamond Digihome DigiLogic digiRED Digitech Digitor Digitrex DiK Dinamic Disney DiViDo DK Digital DMTech Dragon DreamX DSE Dual E Durabrand DVD2000 DVX E:max EagleTec eBench ECC Eclipse Elfunk Elin Elite Ellion Elta Eltax Emerson Enterprise 30490, 30784, 30705, 30714, 30770, 30833, 30869, 30872, 31172, 31483, 31906 31036 30770, 30783, 31115, 31695 30539, 30713, 30723, 30790 30872, 31005 30872 30831 30770, 31115 30490, 30634, 31634, [32134]z 30672, 30699, 30788, 30898, 31056, 31104, 31321, 31923 30665 30843, 31212 30672 30651, 30751, 30768, 30790 30713 30713 30717 31832 30651, 30690, 30833, 31005, 31423 30672, 31004, 31056 30831 30788 30675, 30831, 31270 30705 30831 30783, 31271 30831 31151 30833, 31152, 31730 30651, 30665, 30675, 30713, 30730, 30783, 30790, 30831, 31023 30713, 30831, 31023, 31502 30521 30768 31233, 31321 30714 31152 30730 30723, 30751 30713, 30850, 30884 30770 31152 30850, 31421 30672, 30690, 30770, 30788, 30850, 31051, 31115, 31151, 31233 31233, 31321 30591, 30675, 30705, 30821, 31268 30591 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 13 13 2007/09/28 12:59:31 F Entivo Enzer ESA EuroLine Fenner 30503, 30539 30784, 30770, 31228 30821, 31268 30675, 30788, 31115, 31233 30651 30651, 30695, 30713, 30884, 30898, 31695, 31730 30672, 30591, 30741, 30751, 30770, 30783 30651, 30713, 30843, 30869, 31530 30670 30675, 30695, 31268 30862 31158 30522, 30815, 30717 30717 31051 31224 30768 31152 30573, 30744, 30717, 30715, 30741, 30783, 30833, 30869, 31044, 31075, 31099, 31158, 31483, 31730 30591, 30741, 30869 30651, 30690, 30713, 30723, 30730, 30783, 30790, 30833, 31004, 31140, 31423, 31530, 31730, 31923 31140 30699, 30741 30490, 30651 30665 30831, 30898 30713, 31233 30717 30539, 30651, 30551, 30670, 30686, 30695, 30705, 30713, 30775, 30790, 31004, 31036, 31695, 31730, 31832, 31920 30770, 30790, 30831 30713, 30841, 30850, 31233, 31421 30751, 31152 30843 30741, 30783, 30790 30582, 30702 30788 30705 30730, 31163, 31923 30713 30843 30573, 30664, 30665, 30713, 31247, 31920 30672, 31923 30651, 30713, 30831, 31004, 31224 Ferguson Finlux Firstline G Fisher Funai Fusion Gateway GE General Electric Germatic Global Link Global Solutions Global Sphere Go Video GoldStar Goodmans GP Audio GPX Gradiente Graetz Gran Prix Grandin Greenhill Grundig Grunkel H H&B Haaz Haier Hanseatic Harman/Kardon HCM HDT HE Henss HiMAX Hitachi Hiteker Hoeher 14 I J K L Home Electronics Home Tech Industries Hoyo Humax Hyundai iLo Ingelen Ingersol Initial Inno Hit Insignia Integra Irradio IRT ISP Jamo Jaton JBL JDB JDV Jeken Jepssen JMB JNC JSI 30730, 30770 31224 30665 30646 30783, 30850, 31061, 31228 31348 30788 31023 30839, 30717 30713 31268 30571, 30627, 31634 30869, 31115, 31224, 31233 30783 30695 31036 30665 30702 30730 31367 30699 31250 30695 30672, 31271 31423 30503, 30539, 30558, 30623, JVC 30867, 31164, 31597, 31860 jWin 31051 Kansas Technologies 31233, 31530 Karcher 30783 Kawasaki 30790 Kendo 30672, 30699, 30713, 30831 Kennex 30713, 30770, 30898 Kenwood 30490, 30534 Kiiro 30770 Kiss 30665, 30841, 31523 KLH 30815, 30717, 30790, 31020 Kloss 30533 Koda 31230 Konka 31192 Koss 30651, 31061, 31423 Kreisen 31421 KXD 31321, 31923 Lasonic 30627, 30798, 30789 Lawson 30768 Lecson 31533 Leiker 30872 30651, 30699, 30713, 30770, Lenco 30774 Lenoir 31228 Lenoxx 30690, 30838 Lexia 30699, 30768 LG Lifetec Limit LiteOn Lodos Loewe Logik Logix Luker Lumatron M Lunatron Luxman Luxor Magnasonic Magnat Magnavox Magnex Majestic Manhattan Marantz Mark Marquant Matsui Maxdorf Maxent Maxim Maya MBO McIntosh MDS Mecotek Medion MEI Memorex Metronic Metz MiCO Micromaxx Micromedia Micromega Microsoft Microstar Minato Minax Minerva Minoka Mintek Mirror 30591, 30741, 30790, 30869, 31906 30651, 30831, 31347 30768, 31104 31058, 31158 30713 30539, 30511, 30741, 30885 30713, 30884 30705, 30783 31367 30695, 30705, 30713, 30741, 30833, 31115, 31321, 31832 30741 30573 30713, 31004, 31695, 31730 30651, 30675 31923 30503, 30539, 30646, 30675, 30713, 30821, 30885, 31140, 31268 30723 31345 30705, 30713 30503, 30539, 30675 30713 30770 30672, 30651, 30695, 30713, 30884, 31004, 31695, 31730 30788 31347 30713, 30872, 31367 31345 30690, 30730, 31730 31533 30713 30770 30651, 30630, 30774, 30783, 30831, 31006, 31270, 31345, 31347, 31423 30790 30690, 30695, 30831, 31270 30690 30525, 30571, 30713 30723, 30751, 31223 31695 30503, 30539 30539, 31005 30522, 31708 30831 30752 30713 30705 30770, 31115 30839, 30717 30752 N O Mitsubishi Mizuda Monyka MPX Mustek Mx Onda Mystral NAD Naiko Narita NEC Neovia Nesa Neufunk Nevir NexxTech Nikkai Nintaus Niro Norcent Nordmende Noriko Nova Nowa Nu-Tec Okano Olidata Omni P Onix Onkyo Oopla Oppo Optim Optimus Orbit Orion Oritron Ormond P&B Pacific Packard Bell Palladium Palsonic Panasonic Panda peeKTon Philco Philips 31521, 30521, 30713, 31403 30770, 31451 30665 30843 30730, 31730 30651, 30751, 31223 30831 30741 30770, 31004, 31367 31367 30741, 30869, 31404 31271 30717 30665 30770, 30831, 31197 31402 31923 31051, 31202 32024 30872, 31923 30774, 30831 30752 31923 30843 31228 30752 30672 30690, 30833, 30838, 30862, 31104, 31832 30838 30503, 30627 31158 31224 30843 30525, 30571 30872 30695, 31233, 31695 30651 30713 31451 30695, 30713, 30759, 30768, 30790, 30831 30831 30695, 30713, 31906, 31920 30672, 30852, 31056, 31321 30503, 30490, 30571, 30703, 31362, 31462, 31490, 31579, 31762, 31834, 31905, 31908 30717, 30789, 31203 30898, 31224 30690, 30862 30503, 30539, 30646, 30675, 30854, 30885, 31158, 31260, 31267, 31340, 31354 Philo Phonotrend PianoDisc Pioneer Plu2 Pointer Polaroid Polk Audio Portland Powerpoint Presidian Prima Prinz Prism Pro2 ProCaster Proceed Proline Proscan Proson Prosonic ProVision Q R Pye QONIX Qwestar Radionette RadioShack Raite RCA Realistic REC Redstar Relisys Reoc Revoy Rex Richmond Rio Roadstar S Rocksonic Ronin Rotel Rowa Rownsonic Saba Sabaki Saivod 31345 30699 31024 30490, 30525, 30571, 30631, 31965 30850 30784 31020, 31061, 31086 30539 30770 30872, 31005 30675 31228 30831 30705, 30831 31345 31004 30672 30672, 30651, 30686, 30833, 31004, 31483 30522 30713 30699, 30752 30699, 30730, 31163, 31321, 31923 30539, 30646 31051 30651 30741, 30869, 31906, 32024 30571 30665 30522, 30571, 30717, 30790, 30822, 31022, 31132, 31769, 31913, 31965 30571 30490 30759, 30763, 30770, 30788, 30898, 31345, 31923 31347 30752, 30768 30699, 30841 30838 31233 30869 30672, 30690, 30699, 30713, 30730, 30833, 30898, 31051, 31227 30789 30872 30558, 30623 30717, 30759, 30872, 31004 30789 30651, 3055 30798 30759, 30831, 31367 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 14 2007/09/28 12:59:33 Salora Sampo 30741 30752, 31321, 31347 30490, 30573, 30744, 30199, 30820, 30899, 31044, 31075, 31635, 31932 30784, 30695, 30751, 30763, 30768, 31051, 31228, 31230, 31695, 31832 30670, 30675, 30695, 30713, 30873, 31228 30705, 30850 30730, 31730 31695 30770, 30788, 31115, 31151 30539, 30646, 30651, 30705, 30713, 30774, 30783, 30788, 30790, 30831, 30869, 31367 30752 30768 30672, 30651, 31005, 31036, 31233, 31423 31224, 31451 30798, 30665, 30713, 30763, 30872, 30884, 31483, 31530 31158 30672 30630, 30675, 30713, 30752, 31256, 32015, 32024 31117 30717, 30741, 30770 30717 30533, 30839 31382 31005, 31224 31224 30788, 30898 30831, 30898 31152 30885 30690, 30751, 30768 30672 30539, 30713 30730, 30768 30898 31115 30784 30690, 30730, 30768, 31152 30705, 30713 30755 30831 30573, 30715, 30783, 30869, 31099 30533, 31533, 30864, 30573, 30630, 30772, 31033, 31070, 31431, 31433, 31536, 31633, 31769, 31981, 32043 31233 30768 Samsung Sansui Sanyo Scan ScanMagic ScanSonic Schaub Lorenz Schneider Schwaiger Scientific Labs Scott Seeltech SEG Sensory Science Shanghai Sharp Sharper Image Sherwood Shinco Shinsonic Siemssen Sigmatek Siltex Silva Silva Schneider SilverCrest Simaudio Singer Sistemas Skantic Skymaster Skyworth Sliding Slim Art SM Electronic Smart Sonai Sonashi Sonic Blue Sony Sound Color Soundmaster Soundmax Soundwave Spectra Standard T Star Clusters Starlogic Starmedia Stevison Strong Sunkai Sunstech Sunwood Superscan Supervision SVA Sylvania Symphonic Synn Tandberg Tangent Targa Tatung Tchibo TCL TCM Teac Tec Technica Technics Technika Technisson Technosonic Techwood Tedelex Telefunken Teletech Tensai Tevion Theta Digital Thomson Tivo Tokai Tom-Tec Top Suxess Toshiba TRANS-continents Transonic 30768 30783 30872 30651, 30768, 30788, 30831, 30898 31152, 31227 31005 31005, 31224 31367 30713 30770, 30850 30831 30788, 30898 30821 30768, 31152 30672, 30717, 30752, 31105 30630, 30675, 30821, 31268 30675, 30821, 31268 30768 30713, 31695 31321 31227 30770, 31695 30741 31180 30741, 30790 30571, 30717, 30675, 30741, 30759, 30768, 30790, 30833, 31006, 31197, 31227 30898 31367, 31695 30490, 30703, 31905 30770, 30831, 31115, 31695 31115 30730, 31051, 31115 30713, 31530 30690, 30768, 31004, 31228 30789, 30790, 30833, 31483, 31832, 31923 30713, 30768 30651, 30690, 30770 30651, 30798, 30768, 30833, 30898, 31036, 31227, 31347, 31382, 31483, 31730, 31923 30571 30522, 30511, 30551 31503 30784, 30665, 30788, 30790, 30898 30789 31224 30503, 30573, 30539, 30695, 31045, 31154, 31503, 31510, 31769 30831, 30872, 31321, 31327 30730 U Tredex TruVision Tsinghua Tongfang TSM Umax Unimax United Universum V W Uptek upXus Urban Concepts US Logic Venturer Vestel Victor Vieta Viewmaster Voxson Vtrek Waitec Walkvision Waltham Welkin Wellington Weltstar Wesder Wharfedale X Y Wilson Windsor Windy Sam WIZE Woxter Xbox Xenius XLogic XMS Xoro Yakumo Yamada Yamaha Yamakawa Yukai Z Zenith Zeus 30843 31451 31205 31224 30690, 31151 30770 30675, 30695, 30699, 30713, 30730, 30788, 30884, 31115, 31152, 31228, 31367, 31832 30591, 30713, 30741, 30790, 30869, 31227, 31530, 31913 30763 31345 30503, 30539 30839 30790 30713, 30884, 31530 31597 30705 30862, 31224 30690, 30730, 30774, 30831 31228 31151, 31224, 31233 30717 31530 30831 30713 30713 30699 30686, 30751, 30752, 30790, 31832 30831, 31233 30713 30573 31115 31005, 31151, 31224 30522, 31708 30790 30768, 31152, 31228 30770, 30788 31183, 31250 31004, 31056 30872, 31004, 31056, 31151, 31158 30490, 30539, 30646, 30545, 31354 30665, 30872, 31104 30730, 31730 30503, 30591, 30741, 30869, 31906 30784 DVD Recorder 1 4Kus 31158 A B C D E F G H I J K L M Airis Akira Alba Apex Digital Aristona Aspire Digital Belson Cat cello Centrum Classic Coby Commax Conia CyberHome Cytron Denon Denver Digitrex DSE Durabrand E:max Ellion Eltax Emerson Ferguson Firstline Funai Gateway Go Video Goodmans GPX Grundig H&B Humax iLo JVC Kansas Technologies Kreisen KXD LG Lifetec LiteOn Loewe Lumatron Luxor Magnavox Matsui Maxent MBO Medion MiCO 31321 31321 31530 31056 30646 31168 31086 31421 31730 31227 31730 31086 31321 31321 31129, 31502 31347 30490 31056 31056 31730 31502 31321 31421 31321 30675 31730 31530 30675 31158 30741, 31158, 31730 31530, 31730 30741 31730 31421 30646 31348 31164, 31597 31530 31421 31321 30741 31347 31158 30741 31321 31730 30646, 30675 31730 31347 31730 31347 30751 N O P R S Mitsubishi Mustek NEC Oopla Palsonic Panasonic Philips Pioneer Polaroid ProVision Pye RCA Relisys Roadstar Sampo Samsung ScanMagic Schneider SEG Sensory Science Sharp Sony T U V W Y Z Star Clusters Sylvania Tangent Targa Teac Techwood Tevion Thomson Toshiba Universum Vestel Victor Waltham Yakumo Yamada Yamaha Yukai Zenith 31403 31730 31404 31158 31056, 31321 30490, 31579 30646, 31158 30631 31086 31321 30646 30522 31347 31227 31347 30490, 31635 31730 30646 31530 31158 30630, 30675 31033, 31070, 31431, 31433, 31536 31227 30675 31321 31227 31227 31530 31227, 31347, 31730 30551 31510 31227, 31530 31530 31597 31530 31056 31056, 31158 30646 31730 30741 PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 15 15 2007/09/28 12:59:34 DVD preset codes DVD-Voreinstellungscodes Codes préréglés DVD Codici di preselezione DVD Códigos de preajuste de DVD DVD-voorkeuzecodes Förinställda DVD-koder e Model No. Modellnr Modéle numéro Modello No Nº de modelo Modelnr Modellnr [ [ [ [ [ [ [ ]z: ]z: ]z: ]z: ]z: ]z: ]z: 16 32134 DVD-550 DVD-700 DVD-900 DVD-1000 DVD-1400 DVD-1500 DVD-1710 DVD-1910 DVD-1930 DVD-2200 DVD-2800 DVD-2800g DVD-2900 DVD-2910 DVD-2930 DVD-3800 DVD-3910 DVD-3930 DVD-A11 DVD-A1 DVD-A1XV 30490 DVD-800 DVD-1600 DVD-2000 DVD-2500 DVD-3000 DVD-3300 Preset codes set upon shipment from the factory. Sie Voreinstellungscodes wurden vor der Auslieferung werkseitig eingestellt. Les codes préréglés diffèrent en fonctiom des livraison de l’usine. I codici di presettaggio sono impostati in fabbrica prima della consegna. Los códigos vienen preprogramados de fábrica. Vooringestelde codes bij hey verlaten van de fabriek. Förinställda koder har ställts in vid transporten från fabriken. b1 :These preset codes can be recorded in the SAT/CBL mode. b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im SAT/CBL-Modus aufgenommen werden. b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode SAT/CBL. b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo SAT/CBL. b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo SAT/CBL. b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de SAT/CBL-modus. b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i SAT/CBL-läget. b2 :These preset codes can be recorded in the TV mode. b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im TV-Modus aufgenommen werden. b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode TV. b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo TV. b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo TV. b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de TV-modus. b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i TV-läget. b3 :These preset codes can be recorded in the VCR mode. b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im VCR-Modus aufgenommen werden. b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode VCR. b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo VCR. b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo VCR. b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de VCR-modus. b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i VCR-läget. b4 :These preset codes can be recorded in the DVD mode. b1 :Diese voreingestellten Codes können im DVD-Modus aufgenommen werden. b1 :Ces codes de présélection peuvent être enregistrés en mode DVD. b1 :I codici preimpostati possono essere registrati nel modo DVD. b1 :Es posible guardar estos códigos preajustados en el modo DVD. b1 :Deze voorkeuzecodes kunnen worden opgenomen in de DVD-modus. b1 :Dessa förinställningskoder kan lagras i DVD-läget. PRESET CODE 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 16 2007/09/28 12:59:35 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 17 2007/09/28 12:59:35 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 18 2007/09/28 12:59:35 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 19 2007/09/28 12:59:35 www.denon.com Denon Brand Company, D&M Holdings Inc. Printed in China 00D 511 4733 103 8.AVR2808E2_PresetBack.indd 20 2007/09/28 12:59:35